Trivial typo.
[bpt/emacs.git] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 See the end for copying conditions.
5
6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
7 For older news, see the file ONEWS
8 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
9 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
10
11 Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
15 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
16
17 \f
18 * Installation Changes in Emacs 22.1
19
20 ---
21 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
22 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
23 installed programs.
24
25 ---
26 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
27
28 ---
29 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
30 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.4 or newer. This port
31 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
32
33 ---
34 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with Lisp code.
35
36 ---
37 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
38 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
39 place for game scores to be stored. You can control this with the
40 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
41 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
42 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
43 in each user's home directory.
44
45 ---
46 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
47 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
48 Emacs with Leim.
49
50 +++
51 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
52
53 The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual in Info format is built as part of the
54 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
55 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
56 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
57
58 ---
59 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
60 the distribution.
61
62 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
63 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
64 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
65 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
66
67 ---
68 ** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the
69 following languages: Brasilian Portuguese, Bulgarian, Chinese (both
70 with simplified and traditional characters), French, and Italian.
71 Type `C-u C-h t' to choose one of them in case your language setup
72 doesn't automatically select the right one.
73
74 ---
75 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
76
77 ---
78 ** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand.
79 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
80 the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
81 setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
82
83 ---
84 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
85
86 ---
87 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
88
89 ---
90 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
91
92 ---
93 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
94 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
95
96 ---
97 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
98
99 ---
100 ** Mac OS 9 port now uses the Carbon API by default. You can also
101 create non-Carbon build by specifying `NonCarbon' as a target. See
102 the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
103
104 ---
105 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
106 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
107
108 ---
109 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
110 much pure storage it will approximately need.
111
112 ** The script etc/emacs-buffer.gdb can be used with gdb to retrieve the
113 contents of buffers from a core dump and save them to files easily, should
114 emacs crash.
115
116 ---
117 ** The Emacs terminal emulation in term.el uses a different terminfo name.
118 The Emacs terminal emulation in term.el now uses "eterm-color" as its
119 terminfo name, since term.el now supports color.
120
121 ---
122 ** Emacs Lisp source files are compressed by default if `gzip' is available.
123
124 \f
125 * Startup Changes in Emacs 22.1
126
127 +++
128 ** New command line option -Q or --quick.
129 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
130 the fancy startup screen.
131
132 +++
133 ** New command line option -D or --basic-display.
134 Disables the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, and
135 the blinking cursor.
136
137 +++
138 ** New command line option -nbc or --no-blinking-cursor disables
139 the blinking cursor on graphical terminals.
140
141 +++
142 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
143 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
144 can start with this line:
145
146 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
147
148 +++
149 ** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
150 Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
151 appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
152
153 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
154
155 Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
156 in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
157
158 +++
159 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
160 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
161
162 ---
163 ** If the environment variable DISPLAY specifies an unreachable X display,
164 Emacs will now startup as if invoked with the --no-window-system option.
165
166 +++
167 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
168 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
169 an interactively callable function.
170
171 +++
172 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
173 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
174 affects the initial frame.
175
176 +++
177 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
178 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
179 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
180 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
181 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
182
183 +++
184 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
185 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
186 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
187 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
188 `inhibit-splash-screen').
189
190 +++
191 ** The default is now to use a bitmap as the icon, so the command-line options
192 --icon-type, -i has been replaced with options --no-bitmap-icon, -nbi to turn
193 the bitmap icon off.
194
195 +++
196 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
197 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
198 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
199
200 +++
201 ** Init file changes
202 If the init file ~/.emacs does not exist, Emacs will try
203 ~/.emacs.d/init.el or ~/.emacs.d/init.elc. You can also put the shell
204 init file .emacs_SHELL under ~/.emacs.d.
205
206 +++
207 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
208 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
209 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
210 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
211 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
212 \f
213 * Incompatible Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
214
215 +++
216 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
217 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
218 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
219 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
220
221 +++
222 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
223 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
224
225 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
226 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
227
228 +++
229 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
230 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
231 the operating system or your X server.
232
233 +++
234 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
235
236 +++
237 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
238 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
239 you about it.
240
241 +++
242 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
243 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
244
245 +++
246 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
247 previous mark if you set `set-mark-command-repeat-pop' to t. I.e. C-u
248 C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC
249 to set the mark immediately after a jump.
250
251 +++
252 ** The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
253 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
254
255 +++
256 ** In incremental search, C-w is changed. M-%, C-M-w and C-M-y are special.
257
258 See below under "incremental search changes".
259
260 ---
261 ** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
262
263 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
264 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
265 directory with Dired.
266
267 You can get the old behavior by typing C-x C-f M-n RET, which fetches
268 the actual file name into the minibuffer.
269
270 +++
271 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
272 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
273 it remains unchanged.
274
275 +++
276 ** When Emacs prompts for file names, SPC no longer completes the file name.
277 This is so filenames with embedded spaces could be input without the
278 need to quote the space with a C-q. The underlying changes in the
279 keymaps that are active in the minibuffer are described below under
280 "New keymaps for typing file names".
281
282 +++
283 ** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
284 M-o M-o requests refontification.
285
286 +++
287 ** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
288
289 See below for more details.
290
291 +++
292 ** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
293 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
294 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
295 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
296 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
297 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
298 \f
299 * Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
300
301 +++
302 ** !MEM FULL! at the start of the mode line indicates that Emacs
303 cannot get any more memory for Lisp data. This often means it could
304 crash soon if you do things that use more memory. On most systems,
305 killing buffers will get out of this state. If killing buffers does
306 not make !MEM FULL! disappear, you should save your work and start
307 a new Emacs.
308
309 +++
310 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
311 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
312
313 +++
314 ** You can now switch buffers in a cyclic order with C-x C-left
315 (previous-buffer) and C-x C-right (next-buffer). C-x left and
316 C-x right can be used as well. The functions keep a different buffer
317 cycle for each frame, using the frame-local buffer list.
318
319 +++
320 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
321
322 +++
323 ** M-SPC (just-one-space) when given a numeric argument N
324 converts whitespace around point to N spaces.
325
326 ---
327 ** C-x 5 C-o displays a specified buffer in another frame
328 but does not switch to that frame. It's the multi-frame
329 analogue of C-x 4 C-o.
330
331 ---
332 ** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
333 `insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
334
335 +++
336 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
337 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
338
339 +++
340 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
341 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
342 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
343 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
344
345 +++
346 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
347 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
348 in Indented-Text mode.
349
350 +++
351 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variable references.
352
353 Substrings of the form `$foo' and `${foo}' in the specified new value
354 now refer to the value of environment variable foo. To include a `$'
355 in the value, use `$$'.
356
357 +++
358 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
359 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
360 `same-window'.
361
362 +++
363 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
364 from the locale.
365
366 ** The command `list-faces-display' now accepts a prefix arg.
367 When passed, the function prompts for a regular expression and lists
368 only faces matching this regexp.
369
370 ** Mark command changes:
371
372 +++
373 *** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
374 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
375 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
376
377 +++
378 *** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times.
379
380 If you type C-M-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h
381 (mark-paragraph), or C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region
382 extends each time, so you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC
383 M-C-SPC, for example. This feature also works for
384 mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to a key. It also extends the
385 region when the mark is active in Transient Mark mode, regardless of
386 the last command. To start a new region with one of marking commands
387 in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the active region with C-g,
388 or set the new mark with C-SPC.
389
390 +++
391 *** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
392
393 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
394 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
395 paragraphs.
396
397 +++
398 *** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
399 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
400 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
401 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
402 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
403 command only.
404
405 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
406 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
407 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
408 mark or the region.
409
410 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
411 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
412 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
413 C-g.
414
415 +++
416 *** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
417 `beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
418 is already active in Transient Mark mode.
419
420 ** Help command changes:
421
422 +++
423 *** Changes in C-h bindings:
424
425 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
426
427 C-h d runs apropos-documentation.
428
429 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
430 that do not change:
431
432 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
433 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
434
435 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
436 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
437
438 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
439 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
440 run by the key sequence.
441 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
442 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
443 that command.
444
445 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
446 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
447 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
448 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
449 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
450 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
451 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
452 new-kill-line is on C-k
453
454 ---
455 *** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
456 arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
457 default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
458 `help-default-arg-highlight'.
459
460 +++
461 *** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
462 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
463
464 +++
465 *** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
466 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
467 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
468 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
469 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
470 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
471 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node'). In
472 addition, it now makes hyperlinks to URLs as well if the URL is
473 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `URL'.
474
475 +++
476 *** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
477 description various information about a character, including its
478 encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
479 widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
480 clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
481
482 +++
483 *** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
484 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
485
486 +++
487 *** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
488 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
489 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
490 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
491 keyboard oriented alternative.
492
493 +++
494 *** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
495 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
496 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
497 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
498 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
499
500 +++
501 *** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
502 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
503 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
504 available.
505
506 +++
507 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
508 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
509 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
510 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
511 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
512 matching item.
513
514 ** Incremental Search changes:
515
516 +++
517 *** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
518 To enable this feature, customize the new user option
519 `isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
520 constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
521 for details.
522
523 +++
524 *** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
525 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
526 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
527 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
528
529 +++
530 *** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
531 at the end of a line.
532
533 +++
534 *** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
535 Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
536 and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
537
538 +++
539 *** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
540 `query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
541 search string used as the string to replace.
542
543 +++
544 *** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
545 history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
546 user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
547
548 ** Replace command changes:
549
550 ---
551 *** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
552 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
553 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
554
555 +++
556 *** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
557 `replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
558 where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
559 time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
560 `query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
561 to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
562 All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
563 replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
564 can be edited for each replacement.
565
566 +++
567 *** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
568 `query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
569
570 ---
571 *** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
572 `query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
573
574 ** Local variables lists:
575
576 +++
577 *** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
578 suffix from every line before processing all the lines.
579
580 +++
581 *** Text properties in local variables.
582
583 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
584 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
585
586 +++
587 *** If the local variables list contains any variable-value pairs that
588 are not known to be safe, Emacs shows a prompt asking whether to apply
589 the local variables list as a whole. In earlier versions, a prompt
590 was only issued for variables explicitly marked as risky (for the
591 definition of risky variables, see `risky-local-variable-p').
592
593 At the prompt, you can choose to save the contents of this local
594 variables list to `safe-local-variable-values'. This new customizable
595 option is a list of variable-value pairs that are known to be safe.
596 Variables can also be marked as safe with the existing
597 `safe-local-variable' property (see `safe-local-variable-p').
598 However, risky variables will not be added to
599 `safe-local-variable-values' in this way.
600
601 +++
602 *** The variable `enable-local-variables' controls how local variable
603 lists are handled. t, the default, specifies the standard querying
604 behavior. :safe means use only safe values, and ignore the rest.
605 nil means ignore them all. Anything else means always query.
606
607 +++
608 *** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
609 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
610 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
611 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
612 needed.
613
614 +++
615 *** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
616 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
617 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
618 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
619 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
620 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
621
622 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
623 confirmation as before.
624
625 ** File operation changes:
626
627 +++
628 *** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
629 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
630 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
631 is only rarely needed.
632
633 +++
634 *** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
635 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
636
637 +++
638 *** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
639 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
640
641 +++
642 *** Auto Compression mode is now enabled by default.
643
644 ---
645 *** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
646
647 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
648 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
649 directory with Dired.
650
651 +++
652 *** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
653 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
654 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
655 file.)
656
657 +++
658 *** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
659 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
660
661 +++
662 *** The commands copy-file, rename-file, make-symbolic-link and
663 add-name-to-file, when given a directory as the "new name" argument,
664 convert it to a file name by merging in the within-directory part of
665 the existing file's name. (This is the same convention that shell
666 commands cp, mv, and ln follow.) Thus, M-x copy-file RET ~/foo RET
667 /tmp RET copies ~/foo to /tmp/foo.
668
669 ---
670 *** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
671 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
672 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
673
674 ---
675 *** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
676 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
677 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
678
679 +++
680 *** The new option `write-region-inhibit-fsync' disables calls to fsync
681 in `write-region'. This can be useful on laptops to avoid spinning up
682 the hard drive upon each file save. Enabling this variable may result
683 in data loss, use with care.
684
685 +++
686 *** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
687 Emacs asks for confirmation.
688
689 +++
690 *** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
691
692 `visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
693 when visiting the file.
694
695 `visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
696 needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
697 when saving the file.
698
699 +++
700 *** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
701 major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
702 designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
703 sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
704 So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
705 modes do.
706
707 ** Minibuffer changes:
708
709 +++
710 *** The new file-name-shadow-mode is turned ON by default, so that when
711 entering a file name, any prefix which Emacs will ignore is dimmed.
712
713 +++
714 *** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
715 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
716 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
717 prompt string.
718
719 ---
720 *** Enhanced visual feedback in `*Completions*' buffer.
721
722 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
723 have in common and where they begin to differ.
724
725 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
726 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
727 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
728 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
729 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
730 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
731 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
732 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
733
734 Above fontification is always done when listing completions is
735 triggered at minibuffer. If you want to fontify completions whose
736 listing is triggered at the other normal buffer, you have to pass
737 the common prefix of completions to `display-completion-list' as
738 its second argument.
739
740 +++
741 *** File-name completion can now ignore specified directories.
742 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
743 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
744 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
745 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
746 candidate is a directory.
747
748 +++
749 *** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
750 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
751 it remains unchanged.
752
753 +++
754 *** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
755 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
756 elements are deleted.
757
758 ** Redisplay changes:
759
760 +++
761 *** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
762 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
763 appears between the position information and the major mode.
764
765 +++
766 *** New face `escape-glyph' highlights control characters and escape glyphs.
767
768 +++
769 *** Non-breaking space and hyphens are now displayed with a special
770 face, either nobreak-space or escape-glyph. You can turn this off or
771 specify a different mode by setting the variable `nobreak-char-display'.
772
773 +++
774 *** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
775 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
776 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
777 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
778
779 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
780 hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
781 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
782 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
783 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
784 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
785
786 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
787 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
788
789 ---
790 *** Moving or scrolling through images (and other lines) taller than
791 the window now works sensibly, by automatically adjusting the window's
792 vscroll property.
793
794 +++
795 *** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
796 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
797 the mode line of the currently selected window.
798
799 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
800 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
801
802 +++
803 *** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
804 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
805 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
806 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
807 set-fringe-style.
808
809 +++
810 *** Angle icons in the fringes can indicate the buffer boundaries. In
811 addition, up and down arrow bitmaps in the fringe indicate which ways
812 the window can be scrolled.
813
814 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
815 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
816 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
817
818 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
819 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
820
821 The value can also be an alist which specifies the presence and
822 position of each bitmap individually.
823
824 For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
825 in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
826 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
827 left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
828
829 +++
830 *** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
831 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
832 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
833 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
834 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
835
836 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' can be set to nil to
837 revert to the old behavior of continuing such lines.
838
839 +++
840 *** When a window has display margin areas, the fringes are now
841 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
842 outside those margins.
843
844 +++
845 *** A window can now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
846 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
847
848 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
849 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
850 or when the frame is resized.
851
852 ** Cursor display changes:
853
854 +++
855 *** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
856 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
857
858 +++
859 *** The X resource cursorBlink can be used to turn off cursor blinking.
860
861 +++
862 *** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
863 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
864 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
865 cursor does.
866
867 +++
868 *** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
869 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
870 appears in.
871
872 +++
873 *** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
874 of the recognized cursor types.
875
876 +++
877 *** On text terminals, the variable `visible-cursor' controls whether Emacs
878 uses the "very visible" cursor (the default) or the normal cursor.
879
880 ** New faces:
881
882 +++
883 *** `mode-line-highlight' is the standard face indicating mouse sensitive
884 elements on mode-line (and header-line) like `highlight' face on text
885 areas.
886
887 *** `mode-line-buffer-id' is the standard face for buffer identification
888 parts of the mode line.
889
890 +++
891 *** `shadow' face defines the appearance of the "shadowed" text, i.e.
892 the text which should be less noticeable than the surrounding text.
893 This can be achieved by using shades of grey in contrast with either
894 black or white default foreground color. This generic shadow face
895 allows customization of the appearance of shadowed text in one place,
896 so package-specific faces can inherit from it.
897
898 +++
899 *** `vertical-border' face is used for the vertical divider between windows.
900
901 ** Font-Lock changes:
902
903 +++
904 *** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
905 M-o M-o requests refontification.
906
907 +++
908 *** All modes now support using M-x font-lock-mode to toggle
909 fontification, even those such as Occur, Info, and comint-derived
910 modes that do their own fontification in a special way.
911
912 The variable `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable
913 fontification in Info, remove `turn-on-font-lock' from
914 `Info-mode-hook'.
915
916 +++
917 *** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
918 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
919 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
920 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
921 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
922
923 +++
924 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
925
926 +++
927 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-comment-delimiter-face'.
928
929 +++
930 *** Easy to overlook single character negation can now be font-locked.
931 You can use the new variable `font-lock-negation-char-face' and the face of
932 the same name to customize this. Currently the cc-modes, sh-script-mode,
933 cperl-mode and make-mode support this.
934
935 ---
936 *** The default settings for JIT stealth lock parameters are changed.
937 The default value for the user option jit-lock-stealth-time is now 16
938 instead of 3, and the default value of jit-lock-stealth-nice is now
939 0.5 instead of 0.125. The new defaults should lower the CPU usage
940 when Emacs is fontifying in the background.
941
942 ---
943 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
944
945 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
946 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
947 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
948 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
949
950 ---
951 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
952
953 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
954 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
955 refontification takes place.
956
957 ** Menu support:
958
959 ---
960 *** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
961 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
962 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
963 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
964 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
965 current date and time, current line and column number in the mode-line.
966
967 ---
968 *** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
969
970 ---
971 *** You can exit dialog windows and menus by typing C-g.
972
973 ---
974 *** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
975 and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
976 to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
977
978 +++
979 *** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
980 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
981
982 ---
983 *** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
984 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
985
986 +++
987 *** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have
988 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example
989 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'.
990
991 ---
992 *** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
993 ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
994
995 +++
996 *** For the Gtk+ version, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
997 by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
998 the new dialog.
999
1000 ** Mouse changes:
1001
1002 +++
1003 *** If you set the new variable `mouse-autoselect-window' to a non-nil
1004 value, windows are automatically selected as you move the mouse from
1005 one Emacs window to another, even within a frame. A minibuffer window
1006 can be selected only when it is active.
1007
1008 +++
1009 *** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
1010 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
1011 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
1012 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
1013 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
1014 to give it focus.
1015
1016 +++
1017 *** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
1018
1019 Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
1020 click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
1021 click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
1022 inside a link. Now the behavior of a Mouse-1 click has been changed
1023 to match this context-sentitive dual behavior. (If you prefer the old
1024 behavior, set the user option `mouse-1-click-follows-link' to nil.)
1025
1026 Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs can do much
1027 more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behavior is only
1028 activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
1029 (see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The Lisp
1030 packages that are included in release 22.1 have been adapted to do
1031 this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
1032 is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
1033 happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behavior when you click
1034 on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
1035
1036 If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
1037 just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
1038 click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
1039 you release it).
1040
1041 Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
1042 drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
1043
1044 You can customize the new Mouse-1 behavior via the new user options
1045 `mouse-1-click-follows-link' and `mouse-1-click-in-non-selected-windows'.
1046
1047 +++
1048 *** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
1049 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
1050 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
1051 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
1052 also disable mouse highlighting.
1053
1054 +++
1055 *** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
1056 shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
1057 variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
1058
1059 ---
1060 *** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
1061 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
1062
1063 ---
1064 *** Emacs ignores mouse-2 clicks while the mouse wheel is being moved.
1065
1066 People tend to push the mouse wheel (which counts as a mouse-2 click)
1067 unintentionally while turning the wheel, so these clicks are now
1068 ignored. You can customize this with the mouse-wheel-click-event and
1069 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
1070
1071 +++
1072 *** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
1073
1074 ** Multilingual Environment (Mule) changes:
1075
1076 ---
1077 *** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup
1078 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale
1079 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines.
1080 This change can result in using the different coding systems as
1081 default in some locale (e.g. vi_VN).
1082
1083 +++
1084 *** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
1085 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
1086 can mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
1087 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
1088 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
1089 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
1090 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
1091 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
1092
1093 +++
1094 *** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
1095 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
1096
1097 +++
1098 *** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
1099 coding system.
1100
1101 +++
1102 *** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
1103 of a file.
1104
1105 ---
1106 *** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
1107 unicode.
1108
1109 +++
1110 *** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
1111 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
1112 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
1113 command.
1114
1115 +++
1116 *** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
1117 in the current input method to input a character at point.
1118
1119 +++
1120 *** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
1121 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
1122 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
1123 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
1124 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
1125 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
1126 mule-unicode-... ones.
1127
1128 By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
1129 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
1130 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
1131 possible.
1132
1133 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
1134 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
1135 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
1136 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
1137 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
1138
1139 ---
1140 *** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
1141 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
1142 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
1143 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
1144
1145 ---
1146 *** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
1147 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
1148 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
1149 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
1150 automatically according to the locale.)
1151
1152 ---
1153 *** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
1154 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
1155 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
1156 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
1157 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
1158 tamil-inscript.
1159
1160 ---
1161 *** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
1162 characters.
1163
1164 ---
1165 *** Improved Thai support. A new minor mode `thai-word-mode' (which is
1166 automatically activated if you select Thai as a language
1167 environment) changes key bindings of most word-oriented commands to
1168 versions which recognize Thai words. Affected commands are
1169 M-f (forward-word)
1170 M-b (backward-word)
1171 M-d (kill-word)
1172 M-DEL (backward-kill-word)
1173 M-t (transpose-words)
1174 M-q (fill-paragraph)
1175
1176 ---
1177 *** Indian support has been updated.
1178 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
1179 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
1180 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
1181 supported.
1182
1183 ---
1184 *** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
1185
1186 ---
1187 *** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
1188 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
1189 single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
1190 turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
1191 sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
1192 system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
1193 interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
1194 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
1195 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
1196 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
1197 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
1198 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
1199
1200 ---
1201 *** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
1202 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
1203 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
1204
1205 ---
1206 *** Many new coding systems are available in the `code-pages' library.
1207 These include complete versions of most of those in codepage.el, based
1208 on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now obsolete and is used
1209 only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. All coding systems defined in
1210 `code-pages' are auto-loaded.
1211
1212 ---
1213 *** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
1214 Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
1215
1216 ---
1217 *** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
1218 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
1219 fontset appropriately.
1220
1221 ** Customize changes:
1222
1223 +++
1224 *** Custom themes are collections of customize options. Create a
1225 custom theme with M-x customize-create-theme. Use M-x load-theme to
1226 load and enable a theme, and M-x disable-theme to disable it. Use M-x
1227 enable-theme to enable a disabled theme.
1228
1229 +++
1230 *** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
1231 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
1232 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
1233 faces.
1234
1235 ---
1236 *** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1237 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1238 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1239 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1240 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1241 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1242 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1243
1244 +++
1245 *** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1246 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1247 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1248 under the "[State]" button.
1249
1250 ** Buffer Menu changes:
1251
1252 +++
1253 *** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
1254 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to T in Buffer Menu
1255 mode.
1256
1257 +++
1258 *** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1259 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1260 whose names begin with space are omitted.
1261
1262 ---
1263 *** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
1264 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
1265 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
1266
1267 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
1268 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
1269 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
1270 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
1271 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
1272
1273 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
1274 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
1275 t, and the status is shown.
1276
1277 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
1278 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
1279
1280 ** Dired mode:
1281
1282 ---
1283 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
1284 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
1285 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
1286
1287 +++
1288 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
1289 with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
1290
1291 +++
1292 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
1293 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
1294
1295 +++
1296 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
1297 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
1298 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
1299 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
1300 double quotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
1301 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
1302
1303 +++
1304 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
1305 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
1306
1307 +++
1308 *** In Dired-x, Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode.
1309
1310 The mode toggling command is bound to M-o. A new command
1311 dired-mark-omitted, bound to * O, marks omitted files. The variable
1312 dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the mode toggling function
1313 instead.
1314
1315 +++
1316 *** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1317 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1318 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1319 directory listing into a buffer.
1320
1321 ** Comint changes:
1322
1323 ---
1324 *** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
1325 option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
1326 except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
1327 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
1328 overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
1329
1330 The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
1331 support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
1332
1333 `comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
1334 read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
1335 lines, including any prompts.
1336
1337 `comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
1338 read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
1339 part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
1340 and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
1341 not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
1342 `kill-region' if read-only properties are involved: it copies the text
1343 to the kill-ring, but does not delete it.
1344
1345 +++
1346 *** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
1347 modes (shell-mode, etc.) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1348 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1349 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1350
1351 +++
1352 *** `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields' has been renamed
1353 `comint-use-prompt-regexp'. The old name has been kept as an alias,
1354 but declared obsolete.
1355
1356 ** M-x Compile changes:
1357
1358 ---
1359 *** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
1360
1361 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
1362 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
1363 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
1364 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
1365
1366 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
1367 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
1368 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
1369
1370 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
1371 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
1372 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
1373 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
1374 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
1375
1376 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
1377
1378 +++
1379 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
1380 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
1381 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
1382 subprocesses inherit.
1383
1384 +++
1385 *** New user option `compilation-disable-input'.
1386 If this is non-nil, send end-of-file as compilation process input.
1387
1388 +++
1389 *** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
1390 specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
1391 in new face `next-error'.
1392
1393 +++
1394 *** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
1395 compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
1396 modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
1397 buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
1398 matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
1399 C-c C-f.
1400
1401 +++
1402 *** When the left fringe is displayed, an arrow points to current message in
1403 the compilation buffer.
1404
1405 +++
1406 *** The new variable `compilation-context-lines' controls lines of leading
1407 context before the current message. If nil and the left fringe is displayed,
1408 it doesn't scroll the compilation output window. If there is no left fringe,
1409 no arrow is displayed and a value of nil means display the message at the top
1410 of the window.
1411
1412 ** Occur mode changes:
1413
1414 +++
1415 *** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1416 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1417 switching to it.
1418
1419 +++
1420 *** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
1421 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
1422
1423 +++
1424 *** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1425 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1426 `multi-occur-in-matching-buffers' which allows you to specify the
1427 buffers to search by their filenames or buffer names. Internally,
1428 Occur mode has been rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other
1429 changes.
1430
1431 ** Grep changes:
1432
1433 +++
1434 *** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
1435
1436 There's a new separate package grep.el, with its own submenu and
1437 customization group.
1438
1439 +++
1440 *** `grep-find' is now also available under the name `find-grep' where
1441 people knowing `find-grep-dired' would probably expect it.
1442
1443 +++
1444 *** New commands `lgrep' (local grep) and `rgrep' (recursive grep) are
1445 more user-friendly versions of `grep' and `grep-find', which prompt
1446 separately for the regular expression to match, the files to search,
1447 and the base directory for the search (rgrep only). Case sensitivitivy
1448 of the search is controlled by the current value of `case-fold-search'.
1449
1450 These commands build the shell commands based on the new variables
1451 `grep-template' (lgrep) and `grep-find-template' (rgrep).
1452
1453 The files to search can use aliases defined in `grep-files-aliases'.
1454
1455 Subdirectories listed in `grep-find-ignored-directories' such as those
1456 typically used by various version control systems, like CVS and arch,
1457 are automatically skipped by `rgrep'.
1458
1459 ---
1460 *** The grep commands provide highlighting support.
1461
1462 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
1463 can be saved and automatically revisited.
1464
1465 ---
1466 *** The new variables `grep-window-height' and `grep-scroll-output' override
1467 the corresponding compilation mode settings, for grep commands only.
1468
1469 +++
1470 *** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlights matches in *grep*
1471 buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
1472 --color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
1473 match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
1474 buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
1475 source line is highlighted.
1476
1477 +++
1478 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
1479 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
1480 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
1481 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
1482 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
1483 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
1484 file.
1485
1486 +++
1487 *** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
1488 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1489 detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1490 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1491 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1492 command lines to be used than was possible before.
1493
1494 ** X Windows Support:
1495
1496 +++
1497 *** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
1498 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
1499 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
1500
1501 +++
1502 *** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
1503 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
1504 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
1505 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
1506 Meta and Alt:
1507 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
1508 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
1509
1510 +++
1511 *** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which can
1512 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
1513
1514 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
1515 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
1516
1517 ---
1518 *** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1519 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1520 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1521 and use the more appropriately result.
1522
1523 ---
1524 *** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
1525 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
1526 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
1527
1528 ** Xterm support:
1529
1530 ---
1531 *** If you enable Xterm Mouse mode, Emacs will respond to mouse clicks
1532 on the mode line, header line and display margin, when run in an xterm.
1533
1534 ---
1535 *** Improved key bindings support when running in an xterm.
1536 When emacs is running in an xterm more key bindings are available. The
1537 following should work:
1538 {C,S,C-S,A}-{right,left,up,down,prior,next,delete,insert,F1-12}.
1539 These key bindings work on xterm from X.org 6.8, they might not work on
1540 some older versions of xterm, or on some proprietary versions.
1541
1542 ** Character terminal color support changes:
1543
1544 +++
1545 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
1546 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1547 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1548 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1549 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1550 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1551 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1552 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1553 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1554
1555 ---
1556 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1557 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1558 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1559 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1560 all of these colors.
1561
1562 +++
1563 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1564 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1565 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
1566 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1567 colors as on X.
1568
1569 ---
1570 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1571 \f
1572 * New Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1
1573
1574 ** ERC is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1575
1576 ERC is a powerful, modular, and extensible IRC client for Emacs.
1577
1578 To see what modules are available, type
1579 M-x customize-option erc-modules RET.
1580
1581 To start an IRC session, type M-x erc-select, and follow the prompts
1582 for server, port, and nick.
1583
1584 ---
1585 ** Rcirc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1586
1587 Rcirc is an Internet relay chat (IRC) client. It supports
1588 simultaneous connections to multiple IRC servers. Each discussion
1589 takes place in its own buffer. For each connection you can join
1590 several channels (many-to-many) and participate in private
1591 (one-to-one) chats. Both channel and private chats are contained in
1592 separate buffers.
1593
1594 To start an IRC session, type M-x irc, and follow the prompts for
1595 server, port, nick and initial channels.
1596
1597 ---
1598 ** Newsticker is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1599
1600 Newsticker asynchronously retrieves headlines (RSS) from a list of news
1601 sites, prepares these headlines for reading, and allows for loading the
1602 corresponding articles in a web browser. Its documentation is in a
1603 separate manual.
1604
1605 +++
1606 ** savehist saves minibuffer histories between sessions.
1607 To use this feature, turn on savehist-mode in your `.emacs' file.
1608
1609 +++
1610 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
1611 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
1612 program files that include other program files.
1613
1614 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
1615 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
1616 in them.
1617
1618 +++
1619 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1620
1621 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
1622 Emacs Lisp. The prefix for Calc has been changed to `C-x *' and Calc
1623 can be started with `C-x * *'. The Calc manual is separate from the
1624 Emacs manual; within Emacs, type "C-h i m calc RET" to read the
1625 manual. A reference card is available in `etc/calccard.tex' and
1626 `etc/calccard.ps'.
1627
1628 ---
1629 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
1630 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
1631
1632 ---
1633 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1634
1635 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
1636 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
1637 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
1638 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
1639
1640 +++
1641 ** Image files are normally visited in Image mode, which lets you toggle
1642 between viewing the image and viewing the text using C-c C-c.
1643
1644 ---
1645 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1646
1647 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
1648 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
1649 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
1650 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
1651 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
1652 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
1653
1654 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
1655 rectangle highlighting: Use C-return to start a rectangle, extend it
1656 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
1657 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
1658
1659 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
1660 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
1661 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
1662 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
1663 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
1664 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
1665 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
1666
1667 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
1668 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
1669 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
1670
1671 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
1672 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
1673
1674 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
1675 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
1676 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
1677 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
1678
1679 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
1680 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
1681 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you can customize the
1682 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
1683
1684 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
1685 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
1686 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
1687 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
1688
1689 +++
1690 ** Org mode is now part of the Emacs distribution
1691
1692 Org mode is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining ToDo lists, and
1693 doing project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
1694 It also contains a plain-text table editor with spreadsheet-like
1695 capabilities.
1696
1697 The Org mode table editor can be integrated into any major mode by
1698 activating the minor Orgtbl-mode.
1699
1700 The documentation for org-mode is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
1701 type "C-h i m org RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
1702 available in `etc/orgcard.tex' and `etc/orgcard.ps'.
1703
1704 +++
1705 ** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
1706 The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
1707 to increment the SOA serial.
1708
1709 ---
1710 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
1711 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
1712 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
1713 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
1714 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticeable. The display method can
1715 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
1716
1717 +++
1718 ** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
1719 source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
1720
1721 +++
1722 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
1723 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
1724 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
1725 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
1726 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
1727
1728 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
1729 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
1730 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
1731 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
1732 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
1733 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
1734
1735 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
1736 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
1737 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
1738 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
1739 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
1740 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
1741 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
1742 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
1743 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
1744 or local keymaps.
1745
1746 +++
1747 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
1748 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
1749
1750 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
1751 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
1752 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
1753 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
1754
1755 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
1756 defined macros.
1757
1758 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
1759 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
1760 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
1761 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
1762 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
1763 for more commands.
1764
1765 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
1766 the keyboard macro ring.
1767
1768 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
1769 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
1770
1771 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
1772 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
1773 this behavior via the variables kmacro-call-repeat-key and
1774 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
1775
1776 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
1777 C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
1778 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
1779
1780 ---
1781 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
1782 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
1783 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
1784
1785 +++
1786 ** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
1787 buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
1788
1789 +++
1790 ** The new package longlines.el provides a minor mode for editing text
1791 files composed of long lines, based on the `use-hard-newlines'
1792 mechanism. The long lines are broken up by inserting soft newlines,
1793 which are automatically removed when saving the file to disk or
1794 copying into the kill ring, clipboard, etc. By default, Longlines
1795 mode inserts soft newlines automatically during editing, a behavior
1796 referred to as "soft word wrap" in other text editors. This is
1797 similar to Refill mode, but more reliable. To turn the word wrap
1798 feature off, set `longlines-auto-wrap' to nil.
1799
1800 +++
1801 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1802
1803 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
1804 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
1805 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
1806 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
1807 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
1808 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
1809
1810 ---
1811 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
1812 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
1813 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
1814 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
1815
1816 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
1817
1818 ---
1819 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
1820 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
1821 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
1822 settings.
1823
1824 +++
1825 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
1826 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
1827 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
1828 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
1829
1830 +++
1831 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
1832 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
1833
1834 +++
1835 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
1836 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
1837 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
1838 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
1839 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
1840 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
1841
1842 ** The tumme.el package allows you to easily view, tag and in other ways
1843 manipulate image files and their thumbnails, using dired as the main interface.
1844 Tumme provides functionality to generate simple image galleries.
1845
1846 +++
1847 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
1848
1849 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
1850 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
1851 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
1852 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
1853 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
1854 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
1855 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
1856 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
1857 `rsync' to do the copying).
1858
1859 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
1860 `su' and `sudo'. Ange-FTP is still supported via the `ftp' method.
1861
1862 If you want to disable Tramp you should set
1863
1864 (setq tramp-default-method "ftp")
1865
1866 Removing Tramp, and re-enabling Ange-FTP, can be achieved by M-x
1867 tramp-unload-tramp.
1868
1869 ---
1870 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
1871
1872 ---
1873 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
1874 configuration files.
1875
1876 +++
1877 ** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
1878 varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
1879 var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
1880 section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
1881 .config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
1882 recognized.
1883
1884 ---
1885 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
1886
1887 +++
1888 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
1889
1890 ---
1891 ** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
1892 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
1893
1894 ** The new package scroll-lock.el provides the Scroll Lock minor mode
1895 for pager-like scrolling. Keys which normally move point by line or
1896 paragraph will scroll the buffer by the respective amount of lines
1897 instead and point will be kept vertically fixed relative to window
1898 boundaries during scrolling.
1899
1900 ** The file t-mouse.el is now part of Emacs and provides access to mouse
1901 events from the console. It still requires gpm to work but has been updated
1902 for Emacs 22. In particular, the mode-line is now position sensitive.
1903 \f
1904 * Changes in Specialized Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1:
1905
1906 ** Changes in Dired
1907
1908 +++
1909 *** Bindings for Tumme added
1910 Several new keybindings, all starting with the C-t prefix, have been
1911 added to Dired. They are all bound to commands in Tumme. As a starting
1912 point, mark some image files in a dired buffer and do C-t d to display
1913 thumbnails of them in a separate buffer.
1914
1915 ** Changes in Hi Lock
1916
1917 +++
1918 *** hi-lock-mode now only affects a single buffer, and a new function
1919 `global-hi-lock-mode' enables Hi Lock in all buffers. By default, if
1920 hi-lock-mode is used in what appears to be the initialization file, a
1921 warning message suggests to use global-hi-lock-mode instead. However,
1922 if the new variable `hi-lock-archaic-interface-deduce' is non-nil,
1923 using hi-lock-mode in an initialization file will turn on Hi Lock in all
1924 buffers and no warning will be issued (for compatibility with the
1925 behavior in older versions of Emacs).
1926
1927 ** Changes in Allout
1928
1929 *** Topic cryptography added, enabling easy gpg topic encryption and
1930 decryption. Per-topic basis enables interspersing encrypted-text and
1931 clear-text within a single file to your heart's content, using symmetric
1932 and/or public key modes. Time-limited key caching, user-provided
1933 symmetric key hinting and consistency verification, auto-encryption of
1934 pending topics on save, and more, make it easy to use encryption in
1935 powerful ways.
1936
1937 *** `allout-view-change-hook' marked as being deprecated - use
1938 `allout-exposure-change-hook' instead. Both are currently being used, but
1939 `allout-view-change-hook' will be ignored in a subsequent allout version.
1940
1941 *** Default command prefix changed to "\C-c " (control-c space), to avoid
1942 intruding on user's keybinding space. Customize the
1943 `allout-command-prefix' variable to your preference.
1944
1945 *** Allout now uses text overlay's `invisible' property (and others) for
1946 concealed text, instead of selective-display. This simplifies the code, in
1947 particular avoiding the need for kludges for isearch dynamic-display,
1948 discretionary handling of edits of concealed text, undo concerns, etc.
1949
1950 *** Many substantial fixes and refinements, including:
1951
1952 - repaired inhibition of inadvertent edits to concealed text
1953 - repaired retention of topic body hanging indent upon topic depth shifts
1954 - refuse to create "containment discontinuities", where a
1955 topic is shifted deeper than the offspring-depth of its' container
1956 - bulleting variation is simpler and more accommodating, both in the
1957 default behavior and in ability to vary when creating new topics
1958 - many internal fixes and refinements
1959 - many module and function docstring clarifications
1960 - version number incremented to 2.2
1961
1962 ** The variable `woman-topic-at-point' was renamed
1963 to `woman-use-topic-at-point' and behaves differently: if this
1964 variable is non-nil, the `woman' command uses the word at point
1965 automatically, without asking for a confirmation. Otherwise, the word
1966 at point is suggested as default, but not inserted at the prompt.
1967
1968 ---
1969 ** Changes to cmuscheme
1970
1971 *** Emacs now offers to start Scheme if the user tries to
1972 evaluate a Scheme expression but no Scheme subprocess is running.
1973
1974 *** If a file `.emacs_NAME' (where NAME is the name of the Scheme interpreter)
1975 exists in the user's home directory or in ~/.emacs.d, its
1976 contents are sent to the Scheme subprocess upon startup.
1977
1978 *** There are new commands to instruct the Scheme interpreter to trace
1979 procedure calls (`scheme-trace-procedure') and to expand syntactic forms
1980 (`scheme-expand-current-form'). The commands actually sent to the Scheme
1981 subprocess are controlled by the user options `scheme-trace-command',
1982 `scheme-untrace-command' and `scheme-expand-current-form'.
1983
1984 ---
1985 ** Makefile mode has submodes for automake, gmake, makepp, BSD make and imake.
1986
1987 The former two couldn't be differentiated before, and the latter three
1988 are new. Font-locking is robust now and offers new customizable
1989 faces.
1990
1991 +++
1992 ** In Outline mode, `hide-body' no longer hides lines at the top
1993 of the file that precede the first header line.
1994
1995 +++
1996 ** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
1997
1998 ---
1999 ** The terminal emulation code in term.el has been improved; it can
2000 run most curses applications now.
2001
2002 +++
2003 ** M-x diff uses Diff mode instead of Compilation mode.
2004
2005 +++
2006 ** Diff mode key bindings changed.
2007
2008 These are the new bindings:
2009
2010 C-c C-e diff-ediff-patch (old M-A)
2011 C-c C-n diff-restrict-view (old M-r)
2012 C-c C-r diff-reverse-direction (old M-R)
2013 C-c C-u diff-context->unified (old M-U)
2014 C-c C-w diff-refine-hunk (old C-c C-r)
2015
2016 To convert unified to context format, use C-u C-c C-u.
2017 In addition, C-c C-u now operates on the region
2018 in Transient Mark mode when the mark is active.
2019
2020 +++
2021 ** You can now customize `fill-nobreak-predicate' to control where
2022 filling can break lines. The value is now normally a list of
2023 functions, but it can also be a single function, for compatibility.
2024
2025 Emacs provide two predicates, `fill-single-word-nobreak-p' and
2026 `fill-french-nobreak-p', for use as the value of
2027 `fill-nobreak-predicate'.
2028
2029 ---
2030 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
2031 with special modes such as Tar mode.
2032
2033 ---
2034 ** Commands `winner-redo' and `winner-undo', from winner.el, are now
2035 bound to C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an
2036 incompatible change.
2037
2038 ---
2039 ** `global-whitespace-mode' is a new alias for `whitespace-global-mode'.
2040
2041 +++
2042 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
2043 resync points in both windows.
2044
2045 +++
2046 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
2047
2048 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
2049 starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
2050
2051 ---
2052 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
2053 when Emacs visits them.
2054
2055 ** Info mode changes:
2056
2057 +++
2058 *** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
2059 with the number appended to the `*info*' buffer name (e.g. "*info*<2>").
2060
2061 +++
2062 *** isearch in Info uses Info-search and searches through multiple nodes.
2063
2064 Before leaving the initial Info node isearch fails once with the error
2065 message [initial node], and with subsequent C-s/C-r continues through
2066 other nodes. When isearch fails for the rest of the manual, it wraps
2067 around the whole manual to the top/final node. The user option
2068 `Info-isearch-search' controls whether to use Info-search for isearch,
2069 or the default isearch search function that wraps around the current
2070 Info node.
2071
2072 ---
2073 *** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
2074 `Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
2075 search without prompting for a new search string.
2076
2077 +++
2078 *** New command `Info-history-forward' (bound to r and new toolbar icon)
2079 moves forward in history to the node you returned from after using
2080 `Info-history-back' (renamed from `Info-last').
2081
2082 ---
2083 *** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
2084
2085 ---
2086 *** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
2087 from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
2088
2089 +++
2090 *** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
2091 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
2092 possible matches.
2093
2094 ---
2095 *** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
2096 the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
2097 arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
2098
2099 +++
2100 *** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
2101 and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
2102
2103 ---
2104 *** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
2105 references and following them calls `browse-url'.
2106
2107 +++
2108 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
2109
2110 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
2111 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
2112
2113 ---
2114 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
2115
2116 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
2117 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
2118 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
2119
2120 +++
2121 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
2122
2123 ---
2124 *** `Info-index' offers completion.
2125
2126 ** Lisp mode changes:
2127
2128 ---
2129 *** Lisp mode now uses `font-lock-doc-face' for doc strings.
2130
2131 +++
2132 *** C-u C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-prints the list after point.
2133
2134 *** New features in evaluation commands
2135
2136 +++
2137 **** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
2138 the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
2139
2140 +++
2141 **** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
2142 in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
2143 by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
2144 function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
2145 `eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
2146
2147 +++
2148 ** CC mode changes.
2149
2150 *** The CC Mode manual has been extensively revised.
2151 The information about using CC Mode has been separated from the larger
2152 and more difficult chapters about configuration.
2153
2154 *** Changes in Key Sequences
2155 **** c-toggle-auto-hungry-state is no longer bound to C-c C-t.
2156
2157 **** c-toggle-hungry-state is no longer bound to C-c C-d.
2158 This binding has been taken over by c-hungry-delete-forwards.
2159
2160 **** c-toggle-auto-state (C-c C-t) has been renamed to c-toggle-auto-newline.
2161 c-toggle-auto-state remains as an alias.
2162
2163 **** The new commands c-hungry-backspace and c-hungry-delete-forwards
2164 have key bindings C-c C-DEL (or C-c DEL, for the benefit of TTYs) and
2165 C-c C-d (or C-c C-<delete> or C-c <delete>) respectively. These
2166 commands delete entire blocks of whitespace with a single
2167 key-sequence. [N.B. "DEL" is the <backspace> key.]
2168
2169 **** The new command c-toggle-electric-mode is bound to C-c C-l.
2170
2171 **** The new command c-subword-mode is bound to C-c C-w.
2172
2173 *** C-c C-s (`c-show-syntactic-information') now highlights the anchor
2174 position(s).
2175
2176 *** New Minor Modes
2177 **** Electric Minor Mode toggles the electric action of non-alphabetic keys.
2178 The new command c-toggle-electric-mode is bound to C-c C-l. Turning the
2179 mode off can be helpful for editing chaotically indented code and for
2180 users new to CC Mode, who sometimes find electric indentation
2181 disconcerting. Its current state is displayed in the mode line with an
2182 'l', e.g. "C/al".
2183
2184 **** Subword Minor Mode makes Emacs recognize word boundaries at upper case
2185 letters in StudlyCapsIdentifiers. You enable this feature by C-c C-w. It can
2186 also be used in non-CC Mode buffers. :-) Contributed by Masatake YAMATO.
2187
2188 *** New clean-ups
2189
2190 **** `comment-close-slash'.
2191 With this clean-up, a block (i.e. c-style) comment can be terminated by
2192 typing a slash at the start of a line.
2193
2194 **** `c-one-liner-defun'
2195 This clean-up compresses a short enough defun (for example, an AWK
2196 pattern/action pair) onto a single line. "Short enough" is configurable.
2197
2198 *** Font lock support.
2199 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
2200 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
2201 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
2202 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
2203 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
2204 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
2205
2206 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
2207 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
2208 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
2209 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
2210 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
2211 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
2212 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
2213 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
2214 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
2215
2216 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
2217 fontification in mind; Just-In-Time-Lock mode should be enabled for
2218 the highest font lock level (by default, it is). Fontifying a file
2219 with several thousand lines in one go can take the better part of a
2220 minute.
2221
2222 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
2223 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
2224 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
2225 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
2226 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
2227 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
2228
2229 **** Support for documentation comments.
2230 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
2231 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
2232 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
2233 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
2234
2235 Currently three kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Sun's
2236 Javadoc, Autodoc (which is used in Pike) and GtkDoc (used in C). (The
2237 last was contributed by Masatake YAMATO). This is by no means a
2238 complete list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor
2239 of choice is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2240
2241 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
2242 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
2243 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
2244 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
2245 parens.
2246
2247 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
2248 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
2249 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
2250 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
2251 not as configurable as it ought to be.
2252
2253 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
2254 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
2255 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
2256 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
2257 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
2258
2259 *** Support for the AWK language.
2260 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
2261 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
2262 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
2263 Here is a summary:
2264
2265 **** Indentation Engine
2266 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
2267
2268 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
2269 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
2270 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
2271 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
2272 definition, or structured statement.
2273
2274 The predefined line-up functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
2275 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't
2276 be any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
2277
2278 **** Font Locking
2279 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
2280 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
2281 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
2282 the AWK language itself.
2283
2284 **** Comment and Movement Commands
2285 These commands all work for AWK buffers. The notion of "defun" has
2286 been augmented to include AWK pattern-action pairs - the standard
2287 "defun" commands on key sequences C-M-a, C-M-e, and C-M-h use this
2288 extended definition.
2289
2290 **** "awk" style, Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
2291 A new style, "awk" has been introduced, and this is now the default
2292 style for AWK code. With auto-newline enabled, the clean-up
2293 c-one-liner-defun (see above) is useful.
2294
2295 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
2296 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
2297 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
2298 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
2299 composition-close, and incomposition.
2300
2301 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
2302 The new functions `c-hungry-backspace' and `c-hungry-delete-forward'
2303 provide hungry deletion without having to toggle a mode. They are
2304 bound to C-c C-DEL and C-c C-d (and several variants, for the benefit
2305 of different keyboard setups. See "Changes in key sequences" above).
2306
2307 *** Better control over `require-final-newline'.
2308
2309 The variable `c-require-final-newline' specifies which of the modes
2310 implemented by CC mode should insert final newlines. Its value is a
2311 list of modes, and only those modes should do it. By default the list
2312 includes C, C++ and Objective-C modes.
2313
2314 Whichever modes are in this list will set `require-final-newline'
2315 based on `mode-require-final-newline'.
2316
2317 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
2318
2319 The elements in the syntactic context returned by `c-guess-basic-syntax'
2320 and stored in `c-syntactic-context' has been changed somewhat to allow
2321 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
2322 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
2323
2324 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
2325
2326 is now analyzed as
2327
2328 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
2329
2330 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
2331 symbol.
2332
2333 This change might affect code that calls `c-guess-basic-syntax'
2334 directly, and custom lineup functions if they use
2335 `c-syntactic-context'. However, the argument given to lineup
2336 functions is still a single cons cell with nil or an integer in the
2337 cdr.
2338
2339 *** API changes for derived modes.
2340
2341 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
2342 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
2343 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
2344 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
2345 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
2346
2347 **** New language variable system.
2348 These are variables whose values vary between CC Mode's different
2349 languages. See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
2350
2351 **** New initialization functions.
2352 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
2353 give better control: `c-basic-common-init', `c-font-lock-init', and
2354 `c-init-language-vars'.
2355
2356 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
2357 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
2358 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
2359 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
2360
2361 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
2362 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
2363 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
2364 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
2365 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2366
2367 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
2368 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
2369 its substatement. E.g:
2370
2371 if (x)
2372 x_is_true:
2373 do_stuff();
2374
2375 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
2376
2377 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
2378 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
2379 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
2380 variable `c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros'. A new syntactic symbol
2381 `cpp-define-intro' has been added to control the initial indentation
2382 inside `#define's.
2383
2384 **** New lineup function `c-lineup-cpp-define'.
2385
2386 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
2387 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
2388 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
2389 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
2390 much line `c-lineup-dont-change', which was used earlier, but handles
2391 empty lines within the macro better.
2392
2393 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
2394 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
2395 `c-context-line-break' and `c-context-open-line'.
2396
2397 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2398 `c-backslash-region' tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
2399 variable `c-backslash-max-column' puts a limit on how far out
2400 backslashes can be moved.
2401
2402 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2403 This is controlled by the new variable `c-auto-align-backslashes'. It
2404 affects `c-context-line-break', `c-context-open-line' and newlines
2405 inserted in Auto-Newline mode.
2406
2407 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
2408 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
2409 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
2410 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
2411 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
2412 backslash) in the macro.
2413
2414 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
2415 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
2416 the variable `c-indent-comment-alist'. The indentation behavior is
2417 based on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after
2418 #else and #endif but indentation to `comment-column' in most other
2419 cases (something which was hardcoded earlier).
2420
2421 *** New function `c-context-open-line'.
2422 It's the open-line equivalent of `c-context-line-break'.
2423
2424 *** New lineup functions
2425
2426 **** `c-lineup-string-cont'
2427 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
2428 continues. E.g:
2429
2430 result = prefix + "A message "
2431 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
2432
2433 **** `c-lineup-cascaded-calls'
2434 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
2435
2436 **** `c-lineup-knr-region-comment'
2437 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
2438 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
2439
2440 **** `c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg'
2441 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks.
2442
2443 **** `c-lineup-argcont'
2444 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
2445
2446 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
2447 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
2448 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
2449 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
2450 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
2451 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
2452
2453 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
2454 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
2455 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
2456 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
2457 context.
2458
2459 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
2460 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
2461 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
2462 happen when macros are involved.
2463
2464 *** Improved the way `c-indent-exp' chooses the block to indent.
2465 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
2466 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
2467 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
2468 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
2469 line is left untouched.
2470
2471 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
2472 The function `c-toggle-syntactic-indentation' can be used to toggle
2473 syntactic indentation.
2474
2475 ** In sh-script, a continuation line is only indented if the backslash was
2476 preceded by a SPC or a TAB.
2477
2478 ---
2479 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
2480
2481 ---
2482 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2483 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2484 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2485 C-c C-i b, and so on.
2486
2487 ** Fortran mode changes:
2488
2489 ---
2490 *** Fortran mode does more font-locking by default. Use level 3
2491 highlighting for the old default.
2492
2493 +++
2494 *** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
2495 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
2496 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
2497
2498 +++
2499 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have new navigation commands
2500 `f90-end-of-block', `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block',
2501 `f90-previous-block', `fortran-end-of-block',
2502 `fortran-beginning-of-block'.
2503
2504 ---
2505 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have support for `hs-minor-mode' (hideshow).
2506 It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
2507 majority.
2508
2509 ---
2510 *** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
2511 the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
2512
2513 ---
2514 ** Reftex mode changes
2515
2516 +++
2517 *** Changes to RefTeX's table of contents
2518
2519 The new command keys "<" and ">" in the TOC buffer promote/demote the
2520 section at point or all sections in the current region, with full
2521 support for multifile documents.
2522
2523 The new command `reftex-toc-recenter' (`C-c -') shows the current
2524 section in the TOC buffer without selecting the TOC window.
2525 Recentering can happen automatically in idle time when the option
2526 `reftex-auto-recenter-toc' is turned on. The highlight in the TOC
2527 buffer stays when the focus moves to a different window. A dedicated
2528 frame can show the TOC with the current section always automatically
2529 highlighted. The frame is created and deleted from the toc buffer
2530 with the `d' key.
2531
2532 The toc window can be split off horizontally instead of vertically.
2533 See new option `reftex-toc-split-windows-horizontally'.
2534
2535 Labels can be renamed globally from the table of contents using the
2536 key `M-%'.
2537
2538 The new command `reftex-goto-label' jumps directly to a label
2539 location.
2540
2541 +++
2542 *** Changes related to citations and BibTeX database files
2543
2544 Commands that insert a citation now prompt for optional arguments when
2545 called with a prefix argument. Related new options are
2546 `reftex-cite-prompt-optional-args' and `reftex-cite-cleanup-optional-args'.
2547
2548 The new command `reftex-create-bibtex-file' creates a BibTeX database
2549 with all entries referenced in the current document. The keys "e" and
2550 "E" allow to produce a BibTeX database file from entries marked in a
2551 citation selection buffer.
2552
2553 The command `reftex-citation' uses the word in the buffer before the
2554 cursor as a default search string.
2555
2556 The support for chapterbib has been improved. Different chapters can
2557 now use BibTeX or an explicit `thebibliography' environment.
2558
2559 The macros which specify the bibliography file (like \bibliography)
2560 can be configured with the new option `reftex-bibliography-commands'.
2561
2562 Support for jurabib has been added.
2563
2564 +++
2565 *** Global index matched may be verified with a user function
2566
2567 During global indexing, a user function can verify an index match.
2568 See new option `reftex-index-verify-function'.
2569
2570 +++
2571 *** Parsing documents with many labels can be sped up.
2572
2573 Operating in a document with thousands of labels can be sped up
2574 considerably by allowing RefTeX to derive the type of a label directly
2575 from the label prefix like `eq:' or `fig:'. The option
2576 `reftex-trust-label-prefix' needs to be configured in order to enable
2577 this feature. While the speed-up is significant, this may reduce the
2578 quality of the context offered by RefTeX to describe a label.
2579
2580 +++
2581 *** Miscellaneous changes
2582
2583 The macros which input a file in LaTeX (like \input, \include) can be
2584 configured in the new option `reftex-include-file-commands'.
2585
2586 RefTeX supports global incremental search.
2587
2588 +++
2589 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2590 to support use of font-lock.
2591
2592 ** HTML/SGML changes:
2593
2594 ---
2595 *** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
2596 automatically.
2597
2598 +++
2599 *** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
2600 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
2601 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
2602 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2603 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
2604 from the file name or buffer contents.
2605
2606 +++
2607 *** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
2608
2609 ** TeX modes:
2610
2611 +++
2612 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
2613
2614 +++
2615 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
2616 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
2617 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
2618 TeX commands to use at startup.
2619
2620 ---
2621 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
2622 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
2623
2624 +++
2625 *** New major mode Doctex mode, for *.dtx files.
2626
2627 ** BibTeX mode:
2628
2629 *** The new command `bibtex-url' browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
2630 point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
2631
2632 *** The new command `bibtex-entry-update' (bound to C-c C-u) updates
2633 an existing BibTeX entry by inserting fields that may occur but are not
2634 present.
2635
2636 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
2637
2638 *** `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' can take values `plain',
2639 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
2640 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
2641 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
2642 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
2643 `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' is non-nil.
2644
2645 *** If the new variable `bibtex-parse-keys-fast' is non-nil,
2646 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
2647
2648 *** If the new variable `bibtex-autoadd-commas' is non-nil,
2649 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
2650
2651 *** The new variable `bibtex-autofill-types' contains a list of entry
2652 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
2653
2654 *** The new command `bibtex-complete' completes word fragment before
2655 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
2656
2657 *** The new commands `bibtex-find-entry' and `bibtex-find-crossref'
2658 locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
2659 Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
2660
2661 *** In BibTeX mode the command `fill-paragraph' (M-q) fills
2662 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
2663
2664 *** The new variables `bibtex-files' and `bibtex-file-path' define a set
2665 of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
2666
2667 *** The new command `bibtex-validate-globally' checks for duplicate keys
2668 in multiple BibTeX files.
2669
2670 *** The new command `bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill' pushes summary
2671 of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
2672
2673 *** The new variables bibtex-expand-strings and
2674 bibtex-autokey-expand-strings control the expansion of strings when
2675 extracting the content of a BibTeX field.
2676
2677 *** The variables `bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert' and
2678 `bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert' have been renamed to
2679 `bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert-function' and
2680 `bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert-function'. The old names are
2681 still available as aliases.
2682
2683 +++
2684 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
2685 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
2686 and `C-c C-r'.
2687
2688 ** GUD changes:
2689
2690 +++
2691 *** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
2692 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
2693
2694 ---
2695 *** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
2696 and other common debugger commands.
2697
2698 +++
2699 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
2700 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
2701 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
2702 state of your program. It can separate the input/output of your program from
2703 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
2704 Emacs 21/22 such as the toolbar, and bitmaps in the fringe to indicate
2705 breakpoints.
2706
2707 To use this package just type M-x gdb. See the Emacs manual if you want the
2708 old behaviour.
2709
2710 *** The variable tooltip-gud-tips-p has been removed. GUD tooltips can now be
2711 toggled independently of normal tooltips with the minor mode
2712 `gud-tooltip-mode'.
2713
2714 +++
2715 *** In graphical mode, with a C program, GUD Tooltips have been extended to
2716 display the #define directive associated with an identifier when program is
2717 not executing.
2718
2719 ---
2720 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
2721
2722 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class information.
2723 Fast startup since there is no need to scan all source files up front.
2724 There is also no need to create and maintain lists of source
2725 directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath' and
2726 `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
2727
2728 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
2729 set/clear operations from Java source files under the classpath, stack
2730 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
2731 (gud-finish).
2732
2733 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
2734 (Java 1.1 jdb).
2735
2736 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
2737 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
2738 Set `gud-jdb-use-classpath' to nil.
2739
2740 *** Added Customization Variables
2741
2742 **** `gud-jdb-command-name'. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
2743
2744 **** `gud-jdb-use-classpath'. Allows selection of java source file searching
2745 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan `gud-jdb-directories' for
2746 java sources (previous method).
2747
2748 **** `gud-jdb-directories'. List of directories to scan and search for Java
2749 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2750 is nil).
2751
2752 *** Minor Improvements
2753
2754 **** The STARTTLS wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
2755 instead of the OpenSSL based `starttls' tool. For backwards
2756 compatibility, it prefers `starttls', but you can toggle
2757 `starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
2758 `starttls' tool).
2759
2760 **** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
2761
2762 ** Auto-Revert changes:
2763
2764 +++
2765 *** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
2766
2767 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
2768 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
2769 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
2770 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
2771 just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
2772 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior can
2773 be mode dependent.
2774
2775 If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
2776 then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
2777 mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
2778 toggles this mode.
2779
2780 +++
2781 *** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
2782 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
2783 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
2784 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
2785 mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
2786 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
2787 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
2788 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
2789 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
2790
2791 +++
2792 *** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
2793 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
2794 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
2795 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
2796 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
2797
2798 ---
2799 ** recentf changes.
2800
2801 The recent file list is now automatically cleaned up when recentf mode is
2802 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
2803 automatic cleanup.
2804
2805 The ten most recent files can be quickly opened by using the shortcut
2806 keys 1 to 9, and 0, when the recent list is displayed in a buffer via
2807 the `recentf-open-files', or `recentf-open-more-files' commands.
2808
2809 The `recentf-keep' option replaces `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p'
2810 and provides a more general mechanism to customize which file names to
2811 keep in the recent list.
2812
2813 With the more advanced option `recentf-filename-handlers', you can
2814 specify functions that successively transform recent file names. For
2815 example, if set to `file-truename' plus `abbreviate-file-name', the
2816 same file will not be in the recent list with different symbolic
2817 links, and the file name will be abbreviated.
2818
2819 To follow naming convention, `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag'
2820 replaces the misnamed option `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The
2821 old name remains available as alias, but has been marked obsolete.
2822
2823 +++
2824 ** Desktop package
2825
2826 +++
2827 *** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, `desktop-save-mode'.
2828
2829 +++
2830 *** The variable `desktop-enable' is obsolete.
2831
2832 Customize `desktop-save-mode' to enable desktop saving.
2833
2834 ---
2835 *** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
2836 buffer list.
2837
2838 +++
2839 *** The desktop package can be customized to restore only some buffers
2840 immediately, remaining buffers are restored lazily (when Emacs is
2841 idle).
2842
2843 +++
2844 *** New commands:
2845 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
2846 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
2847 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
2848 it was loaded.
2849 - desktop-lazy-complete runs the desktop load to completion.
2850 - desktop-lazy-abort aborts lazy loading of the desktop.
2851
2852 ---
2853 *** New customizable variables:
2854 - desktop-save. Determines whether the desktop should be saved when it is
2855 killed.
2856 - desktop-file-name-format. Format in which desktop file names should be saved.
2857 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
2858 - desktop-locals-to-save. List of local variables to save.
2859 - desktop-globals-to-clear. List of global variables that `desktop-clear' will clear.
2860 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp. Regexp identifying buffers that `desktop-clear'
2861 should not delete.
2862 - desktop-restore-eager. Number of buffers to restore immediately. Remaining buffers are
2863 restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
2864 - desktop-lazy-verbose. Verbose reporting of lazily created buffers.
2865 - desktop-lazy-idle-delay. Idle delay before starting to create buffers.
2866
2867 +++
2868 *** New command line option --no-desktop
2869
2870 ---
2871 *** New hooks:
2872 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
2873 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
2874
2875 ---
2876 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
2877
2878 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
2879 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
2880 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
2881 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
2882 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
2883 feature.
2884
2885 ** EDiff changes.
2886
2887 +++
2888 *** When comparing directories.
2889 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
2890 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
2891 from one directory to another.
2892
2893 +++
2894 *** When comparing files or buffers.
2895 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
2896 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
2897 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
2898 comparison.
2899
2900 +++
2901 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
2902 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
2903 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
2904
2905 +++
2906 ** Etags changes.
2907
2908 *** New regular expressions features
2909
2910 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
2911
2912 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
2913 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
2914 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
2915 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
2916 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
2917 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
2918 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
2919 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
2920 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
2921 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
2922
2923 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in GCC.
2924
2925 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
2926 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
2927 CR, TAB, VT.
2928
2929 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
2930
2931 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
2932 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
2933 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
2934
2935 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
2936
2937 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
2938 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
2939
2940 *** New language parsing features
2941
2942 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
2943
2944 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
2945
2946 **** The GCC __attribute__ keyword is now recognized and ignored.
2947
2948 **** New language HTML.
2949
2950 Tags are generated for `title' as well as `h1', `h2', and `h3'. Also,
2951 when `name=' is used inside an anchor and whenever `id=' is used.
2952
2953 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
2954
2955 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
2956 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
2957
2958 **** New language Lua.
2959
2960 All functions are tagged.
2961
2962 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
2963
2964 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
2965 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
2966 package::sub.
2967
2968 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
2969
2970 **** New language PHP.
2971
2972 Functions, classes and defines are tags. If the --members option is
2973 specified to etags, variables are tags also.
2974
2975 **** New default keywords for TeX.
2976
2977 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
2978 renewenvironment.
2979
2980 *** Honor #line directives.
2981
2982 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
2983 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
2984 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
2985 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
2986 writes tags pointing to the source file.
2987
2988 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
2989
2990 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
2991 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
2992 reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
2993 the file FILE.
2994
2995 ** VC Changes
2996
2997 +++
2998 *** The key C-x C-q only changes the read-only state of the buffer
2999 (toggle-read-only). It no longer checks files in or out.
3000
3001 We made this change because we held a poll and found that many users
3002 were unhappy with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this
3003 behavior, you can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your
3004 `.emacs' file:
3005
3006 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
3007
3008 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
3009
3010 +++
3011 *** The new variable `vc-cvs-global-switches' specifies switches that
3012 are passed to any CVS command invoked by VC.
3013
3014 These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which means they
3015 are inserted before the command name. For example, this allows you to
3016 specify a compression level using the `-z#' option for CVS.
3017
3018 +++
3019 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
3020
3021 +++
3022 *** VC-Annotate mode enhancements
3023
3024 In VC-Annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
3025 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
3026 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
3027
3028 P: annotates the previous revision
3029 N: annotates the next revision
3030 J: annotates the revision at line
3031 A: annotates the revision previous to line
3032 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
3033 L: shows the log of the revision at line
3034 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
3035
3036 ** pcl-cvs changes:
3037
3038 +++
3039 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
3040 between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
3041 in the repository.
3042
3043 +++
3044 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
3045 anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
3046 `checkout', `update' or `commit'. That means using cvs diff options
3047 -rBASE -rHEAD.
3048
3049 +++
3050 ** The new variable `mail-default-directory' specifies
3051 `default-directory' for mail buffers. This directory is used for
3052 auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to "~/".
3053
3054 +++
3055 ** The mode line can indicate new mail in a directory or file.
3056
3057 See the documentation of the user option
3058 `display-time-mail-directory'.
3059
3060 ** Rmail changes:
3061
3062 ---
3063 *** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
3064
3065 *** The new commands rmail-end-of-message and rmail-summary end-of-message,
3066 by default bound to `/', go to the end of the current mail message in
3067 Rmail and Rmail summary buffers.
3068
3069 +++
3070 *** Support for `movemail' from GNU mailutils was added to Rmail.
3071
3072 This version of `movemail' allows to read mail from a wide range of
3073 mailbox formats, including remote POP3 and IMAP4 mailboxes with or
3074 without TLS encryption. If GNU mailutils is installed on the system
3075 and its version of `movemail' can be found in exec-path, it will be
3076 used instead of the native one.
3077
3078 ** Gnus package
3079
3080 ---
3081 *** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
3082
3083 Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
3084 PGP/MIME.
3085
3086 ---
3087 *** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
3088
3089 See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
3090
3091 ---
3092 ** MH-E changes.
3093
3094 Upgraded to MH-E version 8.0. There have been major changes since
3095 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
3096
3097 ** Calendar changes:
3098
3099 +++
3100 *** You can now use < and >, instead of C-x < and C-x >, to scroll
3101 the calendar left or right. (The old key bindings still work too.)
3102
3103 +++
3104 *** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
3105 convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
3106
3107 +++
3108 *** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
3109 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
3110 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
3111 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
3112 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
3113 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
3114 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
3115 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
3116 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
3117
3118 +++
3119 *** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
3120 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
3121 count backward from the end of the year.
3122
3123 +++
3124 *** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
3125 prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
3126 day of that ISO week.
3127
3128 ---
3129 *** The new variable `calendar-minimum-window-height' affects the
3130 window generated by the function `generate-calendar-window'.
3131
3132 ---
3133 *** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
3134 optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
3135 rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
3136 `christian-holidays' simpler.
3137
3138 ---
3139 *** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
3140 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
3141 and `diary-header-line-format'.
3142
3143 +++
3144 *** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed:
3145 use the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
3146 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
3147 `appt-issue-message', `appt-visible', and `appt-msg-window'.
3148
3149 +++
3150 *** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
3151 and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
3152 from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
3153 `diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
3154 formats.
3155
3156 +++
3157 ** Speedbar changes:
3158
3159 *** Speedbar items can now be selected by clicking mouse-1, based on
3160 the `mouse-1-click-follows-link' mechanism.
3161
3162 *** SPC and DEL are no longer bound to scroll up/down in the speedbar
3163 keymap.
3164
3165 *** The new command `speedbar-toggle-line-expansion', bound to SPC,
3166 contracts or expands the line under the cursor.
3167
3168 *** New command `speedbar-create-directory', bound to `M'.
3169
3170 *** The new commands `speedbar-expand-line-descendants' and
3171 `speedbar-contract-line-descendants', bound to `[' and `]'
3172 respectively, expand and contract the line under cursor with all of
3173 its descendents.
3174
3175 *** The new user option `speedbar-query-confirmation-method' controls
3176 how querying is performed for file operations. A value of 'always
3177 means to always query before file operations; 'none-but-delete means
3178 to not query before any file operations, except before a file
3179 deletion.
3180
3181 *** The new user option `speedbar-select-frame-method' specifies how
3182 to select a frame for displaying a file opened with the speedbar. A
3183 value of 'attached means to use the attached frame (the frame that
3184 speedbar was started from.) A number such as 1 or -1 means to pass
3185 that number to `other-frame'.
3186
3187 *** The new user option `speedbar-use-tool-tips-flag', if non-nil,
3188 means to display tool-tips for speedbar items.
3189
3190 *** The frame management code in speedbar.el has been split into a new
3191 `dframe' library. Emacs Lisp code that makes use of the speedbar
3192 should use `dframe-attached-frame' instead of
3193 `speedbar-attached-frame', `dframe-timer' instead of `speedbar-timer',
3194 `dframe-close-frame' instead of `speedbar-close-frame', and
3195 `dframe-activity-change-focus-flag' instead of
3196 `speedbar-activity-change-focus-flag'. The variables
3197 `speedbar-update-speed' and `speedbar-navigating-speed' are also
3198 obsolete; use `dframe-update-speed' instead.
3199
3200 ---
3201 ** sql changes.
3202
3203 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlighting of different
3204 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
3205 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
3206 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
3207 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
3208
3209 The following values are supported:
3210
3211 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
3212 db2 DB2
3213 informix Informix
3214 ingres Ingres
3215 interbase Interbase
3216 linter Linter
3217 ms Microsoft
3218 mysql MySQL
3219 oracle Oracle
3220 postgres Postgres
3221 solid Solid
3222 sqlite SQLite
3223 sybase Sybase
3224
3225 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
3226 SQL mode indicator.
3227
3228 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
3229 your `.emacs' will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
3230 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
3231
3232 ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
3233
3234 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
3235 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
3236 all identifiers ending in `_t' under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
3237 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
3238
3239 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
3240 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
3241
3242 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i.
3243
3244 Most SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
3245 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
3246
3247 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
3248
3249 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
3250 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
3251 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
3252 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
3253 terminated.
3254
3255 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
3256 called with the `-E' command line argument to use the operating system
3257 credentials to authenticate the user.
3258
3259 *** Postgres support is enhanced.
3260 Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
3261 the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
3262
3263 *** MySQL support is enhanced.
3264 Keyword highlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
3265
3266 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
3267 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
3268 defaults.
3269
3270 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
3271 appropriate `sql-interactive-mode' wrapper for the current setting of
3272 `sql-product'.
3273
3274 ---
3275 *** sql.el supports the SQLite interpreter--call 'sql-sqlite'.
3276
3277 ** FFAP changes:
3278
3279 +++
3280 *** New ffap commands and keybindings:
3281
3282 C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
3283 C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
3284 C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
3285 C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
3286
3287 ---
3288 *** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default.
3289
3290 C-x C-f passes the file name to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS
3291 argument, which visits multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
3292
3293 ---
3294 ** In skeleton.el, `-' marks the `skeleton-point' without interregion interaction.
3295
3296 `@' has reverted to only setting `skeleton-positions' and no longer
3297 sets `skeleton-point'. Skeletons which used @ to mark
3298 `skeleton-point' independent of `_' should now use `-' instead. The
3299 updated `skeleton-insert' docstring explains these new features along
3300 with other details of skeleton construction.
3301
3302 ---
3303 ** Hideshow mode changes
3304
3305 *** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
3306 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
3307 handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
3308 temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
3309
3310 *** New variable `hs-allow-nesting' non-nil means that hiding a block does
3311 not discard the hidden state of any "internal" blocks; when the parent
3312 block is later shown, the internal blocks remain hidden. Default is nil.
3313
3314 +++
3315 ** `hide-ifdef-mode' now uses overlays rather than selective-display
3316 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
3317 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
3318
3319 ---
3320 ** `partial-completion-mode' now handles partial completion on directory names.
3321
3322 ---
3323 ** The type-break package now allows `type-break-file-name' to be nil
3324 and if so, doesn't store any data across sessions. This is handy if
3325 you don't want the `.type-break' file in your home directory or are
3326 annoyed by the need for interaction when you kill Emacs.
3327
3328 ---
3329 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
3330
3331 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
3332 `ps-print', provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF
3333 fonts. See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
3334
3335 ---
3336 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
3337 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
3338 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
3339 using strokes as an input method.
3340
3341 ** Emacs server changes:
3342
3343 +++
3344 *** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
3345
3346 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
3347 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
3348 % emacsclient -s foo file1
3349 % emacsclient -s bar file2
3350
3351 +++
3352 *** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
3353 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given Lisp
3354 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
3355
3356 +++
3357 *** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
3358
3359 ---
3360 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
3361
3362 +++
3363 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
3364
3365 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
3366 argument it toggles the mode. Turning off PC-Selection mode restores
3367 the global key bindings that were replaced by turning on the mode.
3368
3369 ---
3370 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
3371 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
3372
3373 ---
3374 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
3375
3376 Emacs still works on terminals that require magic cookies in order to
3377 use standout mode, but they can no longer display mode-lines in
3378 inverse-video.
3379
3380 ---
3381 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
3382
3383 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
3384 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
3385 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
3386
3387 ** battery.el changes:
3388
3389 ---
3390 *** display-battery-mode replaces display-battery.
3391
3392 ---
3393 *** battery.el now works on recent versions of OS X.
3394
3395 ---
3396 ** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode.
3397
3398 To enable this, set `calculator-output-radix' non-nil. In this mode a
3399 separator character is used every few digits, making it easier to see
3400 byte boundaries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the
3401 variable `calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
3402
3403 ---
3404 ** fast-lock.el and lazy-lock.el are obsolete. Use jit-lock.el instead.
3405
3406 ---
3407 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead.
3408
3409 ---
3410 ** cplus-md.el has been deleted.
3411 \f
3412 * Changes in Emacs 22.1 on non-free operating systems
3413
3414 +++
3415 ** The HOME directory defaults to Application Data under the user profile.
3416
3417 If you used a previous version of Emacs without setting the HOME
3418 environment variable and a `.emacs' was saved, then Emacs will continue
3419 using C:/ as the default HOME. But if you are installing Emacs afresh,
3420 the default location will be the "Application Data" (or similar
3421 localized name) subdirectory of your user profile. A typical location
3422 of this directory is "C:\Documents and Settings\USERNAME\Application Data",
3423 where USERNAME is your user name.
3424
3425 This change means that users can now have their own `.emacs' files on
3426 shared computers, and the default HOME directory is less likely to be
3427 read-only on computers that are administered by someone else.
3428
3429 +++
3430 ** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
3431
3432 You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
3433 existing values. For example:
3434
3435 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
3436
3437 will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
3438 irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
3439
3440 ---
3441 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
3442
3443 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
3444 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
3445
3446 ---
3447 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
3448
3449 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
3450
3451 ---
3452 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
3453
3454 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
3455 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
3456 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
3457 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
3458 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
3459 against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
3460
3461 ---
3462 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
3463
3464 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
3465 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
3466 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
3467 sound support for those formats.
3468
3469 ---
3470 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
3471
3472 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
3473
3474 ---
3475 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
3476
3477 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
3478 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
3479 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
3480
3481 ---
3482 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
3483
3484 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
3485 the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
3486 colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
3487 default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
3488 some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
3489 `list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
3490 you wish to use them in other faces.
3491
3492 ---
3493 ** On MS Windows NT/W2K/XP, Emacs uses Unicode for clipboard operations.
3494
3495 Those systems use Unicode internally, so this allows Emacs to share
3496 multilingual text with other applications. On other versions of
3497 MS Windows, Emacs now uses the appropriate locale coding-system, so
3498 the clipboard should work correctly for your local language without
3499 any customizations.
3500
3501 ---
3502 ** Running in a console window in Windows now uses the console size.
3503
3504 Previous versions of Emacs erred on the side of having a usable Emacs
3505 through telnet, even though that was inconvenient if you use Emacs in
3506 a local console window with a scrollback buffer. The default value of
3507 w32-use-full-screen-buffer is now nil, which favors local console
3508 windows. Recent versions of Windows telnet also work well with this
3509 setting. If you are using an older telnet server then Emacs detects
3510 that the console window dimensions that are reported are not sane, and
3511 defaults to 80x25. If you use such a telnet server regularly at a size
3512 other than 80x25, you can still manually set
3513 w32-use-full-screen-buffer to t.
3514
3515 ---
3516 ** On Mac OS, `keyboard-coding-system' changes based on the keyboard script.
3517
3518 ---
3519 ** The variable `mac-keyboard-text-encoding' and the constants
3520 `kTextEncodingMacRoman', `kTextEncodingISOLatin1', and
3521 `kTextEncodingISOLatin2' are obsolete.
3522
3523 ** The variable `mac-command-key-is-meta' is obsolete. Use
3524 `mac-command-modifier' and `mac-option-modifier' instead.
3525 \f
3526 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3527
3528 ---
3529 ** The variables post-command-idle-hook and post-command-idle-delay have
3530 been removed. Use run-with-idle-timer instead.
3531
3532 +++
3533 ** `suppress-keymap' now works by remapping `self-insert-command' to
3534 the command `undefined'. (In earlier Emacs versions, it used
3535 `substitute-key-definition' to rebind self inserting characters to
3536 `undefined'.)
3537
3538 +++
3539 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3540 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3541 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
3542
3543 ---
3544 The function `comint-send-input' now accepts 3 optional arguments:
3545
3546 (comint-send-input &optional no-newline artificial)
3547
3548 Callers sending input not from the user should use bind the 3rd
3549 argument `artificial' to a non-nil value, to prevent Emacs from
3550 deleting the part of subprocess output that matches the input.
3551
3552 ---
3553 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3554
3555 +++
3556 ** The variable `memory-full' now remains t until
3557 there is no longer a shortage of memory.
3558 \f
3559 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3560
3561 ** General Lisp changes:
3562
3563 *** The function `expt' handles negative exponents differently.
3564 The value for `(expt A B)', if both A and B are integers and B is
3565 negative, is now a float. For example: (expt 2 -2) => 0.25.
3566
3567 +++
3568 *** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
3569
3570 +++
3571 *** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
3572
3573 +++
3574 *** `add-to-list' takes an optional third argument, APPEND.
3575
3576 If APPEND is non-nil, the new element gets added at the end of the
3577 list instead of at the beginning. This change actually occurred in
3578 Emacs 21.1, but was not documented then.
3579
3580 +++
3581 *** New function `add-to-ordered-list' is like `add-to-list' but
3582 associates a numeric ordering of each element added to the list.
3583
3584 +++
3585 *** New function `copy-tree' makes a copy of a tree.
3586
3587 It recursively copies through both CARs and CDRs.
3588
3589 +++
3590 *** New function `delete-dups' deletes `equal' duplicate elements from a list.
3591
3592 It modifies the list destructively, like `delete'. Of several `equal'
3593 occurrences of an element in the list, the one that's kept is the
3594 first one.
3595
3596 +++
3597 *** New function `add-to-history' adds an element to a history list.
3598
3599 Lisp packages should use this function to add elements to their
3600 history lists.
3601
3602 If `history-delete-duplicates' is non-nil, it removes duplicates of
3603 the new element from the history list it updates.
3604
3605 +++
3606 *** New function `rassq-delete-all'.
3607
3608 (rassq-delete-all VALUE ALIST) deletes, from ALIST, each element whose
3609 CDR is `eq' to the specified value.
3610
3611 +++
3612 *** The function `number-sequence' makes a list of equally-separated numbers.
3613
3614 For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9). By
3615 default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different
3616 separation as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns
3617 (1.5 3.5 5.5).
3618
3619 +++
3620 *** New variables `most-positive-fixnum' and `most-negative-fixnum'.
3621
3622 They hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
3623
3624 +++
3625 *** Minor change in the function `format'.
3626
3627 Some flags that were accepted but not implemented (such as "*") are no
3628 longer accepted.
3629
3630 +++
3631 *** Functions `get' and `plist-get' no longer give errors for bad plists.
3632
3633 They return nil for a malformed property list or if the list is
3634 cyclic.
3635
3636 +++
3637 *** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
3638
3639 They are like `plist-get' and `plist-put', except that they compare
3640 the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
3641
3642 +++
3643 *** New variable `print-continuous-numbering'.
3644
3645 When this is non-nil, successive calls to print functions use a single
3646 numbering scheme for circular structure references. This is only
3647 relevant when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3648
3649 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3650 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
3651
3652 +++
3653 *** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
3654
3655 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
3656 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
3657 if no expansion is done, which can be tested using `eq'.
3658
3659 +++
3660 *** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3661
3662 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3663 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3664 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
3665
3666 +++
3667 *** A function or macro's doc string can now specify the calling pattern.
3668
3669 You put this info in the doc string's last line. It should be
3670 formatted so as to match the regexp "\n\n(fn .*)\\'". If you don't
3671 specify this explicitly, Emacs determines it from the actual argument
3672 names. Usually that default is right, but not always.
3673
3674 +++
3675 *** New macro `with-local-quit' temporarily allows quitting.
3676
3677 A quit inside the body of `with-local-quit' is caught by the
3678 `with-local-quit' form itself, but another quit will happen later once
3679 the code that has inhibited quitting exits.
3680
3681 This is for use around potentially blocking or long-running code
3682 inside timer functions and `post-command-hook' functions.
3683
3684 +++
3685 *** New macro `define-obsolete-function-alias'.
3686
3687 This combines `defalias' and `make-obsolete'.
3688
3689 +++
3690 *** New function `unsafep' determines whether a Lisp form is safe.
3691
3692 It returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly do anything
3693 dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be unsafe
3694 (calls unknown function, alters global variable, etc.).
3695
3696 +++
3697 *** New macro `eval-at-startup' specifies expressions to
3698 evaluate when Emacs starts up. If this is done after startup,
3699 it evaluates those expressions immediately.
3700
3701 This is useful in packages that can be preloaded.
3702
3703 *** `list-faces-display' takes an optional argument, REGEXP.
3704
3705 If it is non-nil, the function lists only faces matching this regexp.
3706
3707 +++
3708 *** New functions `string-or-null-p' and `booleanp'.
3709
3710 `string-or-null-p' returns non-nil iff OBJECT is a string or nil.
3711 `booleanp' returns non-nil iff OBJECT is a t or nil.
3712
3713 ** Lisp code indentation features:
3714
3715 +++
3716 *** The `defmacro' form can contain indentation and edebug declarations.
3717
3718 These declarations specify how to indent the macro calls in Lisp mode
3719 and how to debug them with Edebug. You write them like this:
3720
3721 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3722
3723 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3724 possible declaration specifiers are:
3725
3726 (indent INDENT)
3727 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3728
3729 (edebug DEBUG)
3730 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3731 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro,
3732 but this is cleaner.)
3733
3734 ---
3735 *** cl-indent now allows customization of Indentation of backquoted forms.
3736
3737 See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3738
3739 ---
3740 *** cl-indent now handles indentation of simple and extended `loop' forms.
3741
3742 The new user options `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation',
3743 `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can
3744 be used to customize the indentation of keywords and forms in loop
3745 forms.
3746
3747 +++
3748 ** Variable aliases:
3749
3750 *** New function: defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
3751
3752 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3753 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3754 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3755 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
3756
3757 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3758 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3759
3760 *** New function: indirect-variable VARIABLE
3761
3762 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3763 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3764 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3765
3766 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3767 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
3768
3769 +++
3770 *** The macro `define-obsolete-variable-alias' combines `defvaralias' and
3771 `make-obsolete-variable'.
3772
3773 ** defcustom changes:
3774
3775 +++
3776 *** The package-version keyword has been added to provide
3777 `customize-changed-options' functionality to packages in the future.
3778 Developers who make use of this keyword must also update the new
3779 variable `customize-package-emacs-version-alist'.
3780
3781 +++
3782 *** The new customization type `float' requires a floating point number.
3783
3784 ** String changes:
3785
3786 +++
3787 *** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character.
3788
3789 Exception: In a character constant, if it is followed by a `-' in a
3790 character constant (e.g. ?\s-A), it is still interpreted as the super
3791 modifier. In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
3792
3793 +++
3794 *** A hex escape in a string constant forces the string to be multibyte.
3795
3796 +++
3797 *** An octal escape in a string constant forces the string to be unibyte.
3798
3799 +++
3800 *** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
3801 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
3802 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
3803 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
3804 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
3805
3806 +++
3807 *** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3808 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
3809
3810 +++
3811 *** New function `substring-no-properties' returns a substring without
3812 text properties.
3813
3814 +++
3815 *** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
3816 `assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
3817 been declared obsolete.
3818
3819 +++
3820 ** Displaying warnings to the user.
3821
3822 See the functions `warn' and `display-warning', or the Lisp Manual.
3823 If you want to be sure the warning will not be overlooked, this
3824 facility is much better than using `message', since it displays
3825 warnings in a separate window.
3826
3827 +++
3828 ** Progress reporters.
3829
3830 These provide a simple and uniform way for commands to present
3831 progress messages for the user.
3832
3833 See the new functions `make-progress-reporter',
3834 `progress-reporter-update', `progress-reporter-force-update',
3835 `progress-reporter-done', and `dotimes-with-progress-reporter'.
3836
3837 ** Buffer positions:
3838
3839 +++
3840 *** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
3841 width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
3842 the usable window height and width is used.
3843
3844 +++
3845 *** The `line-move', `scroll-up', and `scroll-down' functions will now
3846 modify the window vscroll to scroll through display rows that are
3847 taller that the height of the window, for example in the presence of
3848 large images. To disable this feature, bind the new variable
3849 `auto-window-vscroll' to nil.
3850
3851 +++
3852 *** The argument to `forward-word', `backward-word' is optional.
3853
3854 It defaults to 1.
3855
3856 +++
3857 *** Argument to `forward-to-indentation' and `backward-to-indentation' is optional.
3858
3859 It defaults to 1.
3860
3861 +++
3862 *** New function `mouse-on-link-p' tests if a position is in a clickable link.
3863
3864 This is the function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link'
3865 functionality.
3866
3867 +++
3868 *** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns the line number of a position.
3869
3870 It an optional buffer position argument that defaults to point.
3871
3872 +++
3873 *** `field-beginning' and `field-end' take new optional argument, LIMIT.
3874
3875 This argument tells them not to search beyond LIMIT. Instead they
3876 give up and return LIMIT.
3877
3878 +++
3879 *** Function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now returns the pixel coordinates
3880 and partial visibility state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
3881 arg is non-nil.
3882
3883 +++
3884 *** New functions `posn-at-point' and `posn-at-x-y' return
3885 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
3886 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
3887
3888 ** Text modification:
3889
3890 +++
3891 *** The new function `insert-for-yank' normally works like `insert', but
3892 removes the text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list
3893 and handles the `yank-handler' text property.
3894
3895 +++
3896 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-as-yank' is like
3897 `insert-for-yank' except that it gets the text from another buffer as
3898 in `insert-buffer-substring'.
3899
3900 +++
3901 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-no-properties' is like
3902 `insert-buffer-substring', but removes all text properties from the
3903 inserted substring.
3904
3905 +++
3906 *** The new function `filter-buffer-substring' extracts a buffer
3907 substring, passes it through a set of filter functions, and returns
3908 the filtered substring. Use it instead of `buffer-substring' or
3909 `delete-and-extract-region' when copying text into a user-accessible
3910 data structure, such as the kill-ring, X clipboard, or a register.
3911
3912 The list of filter function is specified by the new variable
3913 `buffer-substring-filters'. For example, Longlines mode adds to
3914 `buffer-substring-filters' to remove soft newlines from the copied
3915 text.
3916
3917 +++
3918 *** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
3919 argument.
3920
3921 +++
3922 *** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3923 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3924 be inserted is translated through it.
3925
3926 ---
3927 *** Text clones.
3928
3929 The new function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3930 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3931 clone to the other.
3932
3933 ---
3934 *** The function `insert-string' is now obsolete.
3935
3936 ** Filling changes.
3937
3938 +++
3939 *** In determining an adaptive fill prefix, Emacs now tries the function in
3940 `adaptive-fill-function' _before_ matching the buffer line against
3941 `adaptive-fill-regexp' rather than _after_ it.
3942
3943 +++
3944 ** Atomic change groups.
3945
3946 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3947 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3948 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3949
3950 (atomic-change-group
3951 (insert foo)
3952 (delete-region x y))
3953
3954 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3955 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3956 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3957 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3958
3959 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3960 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3961
3962 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3963 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3964 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3965 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3966
3967 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3968 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3969 do this.
3970
3971 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3972 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3973 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3974 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3975
3976 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3977 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3978 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3979 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3980 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3981 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3982 twice.
3983
3984 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3985 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3986 returned values, like this:
3987
3988 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3989 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3990
3991 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3992 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3993 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3994
3995 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3996 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3997 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3998 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3999 finished.
4000
4001 ** Buffer-related changes:
4002
4003 ---
4004 *** `list-buffers-noselect' now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
4005
4006 If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
4007
4008 +++
4009 *** `kill-buffer-hook' is now a permanent local.
4010
4011 +++
4012 *** The new function `buffer-local-value' returns the buffer-local
4013 binding of VARIABLE (a symbol) in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not
4014 have a buffer-local binding in buffer BUFFER, it returns the default
4015 value of VARIABLE instead.
4016
4017 *** The function `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' now lets you maintain
4018 various status records in parallel.
4019
4020 It takes a variable (a symbol) as argument. If the variable is non-nil,
4021 then its value should be a vector installed previously by
4022 `frame-or-buffer-changed-p'. If the frame names, buffer names, buffer
4023 order, or their read-only or modified flags have changed, since the
4024 time the vector's contents were recorded by a previous call to
4025 `frame-or-buffer-changed-p', then the function returns t. Otherwise
4026 it returns nil.
4027
4028 On the first call to `frame-or-buffer-changed-p', the variable's
4029 value should be nil. `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' stores a suitable
4030 vector into the variable and returns t.
4031
4032 If the variable is itself nil, then `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' uses,
4033 for compatibility, an internal variable which exists only for this
4034 purpose.
4035
4036 +++
4037 *** The function `read-buffer' follows the convention for reading from
4038 the minibuffer with a default value: if DEF is non-nil, the minibuffer
4039 prompt provided in PROMPT is edited to show the default value provided
4040 in DEF before the terminal colon and space.
4041
4042 ** Searching and matching changes:
4043
4044 +++
4045 *** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
4046 the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
4047 back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
4048
4049 +++
4050 *** The new variable `search-spaces-regexp' controls how to search
4051 for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
4052 regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
4053 expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
4054
4055 Spaces inside of constructs such as `[..]' and inside loops such as
4056 `*', `+', and `?' are never replaced with `search-spaces-regexp'.
4057
4058 +++
4059 *** New regular expression operators, `\_<' and `\_>'.
4060
4061 These match the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
4062 non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
4063 specified by the syntax table.
4064
4065 ---
4066 *** rx.el has new corresponding `symbol-end' and `symbol-start' elements.
4067
4068 +++
4069 *** `skip-chars-forward' and `skip-chars-backward' now handle
4070 character classes such as `[:alpha:]', along with individual
4071 characters and ranges.
4072
4073 ---
4074 *** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
4075 properties from surrounding text.
4076
4077 +++
4078 *** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
4079 element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
4080 accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
4081
4082 +++
4083 *** Functions `match-data' and `set-match-data' now have an optional
4084 argument `reseat'. When non-nil, all markers in the match data list
4085 passed to these functions will be reseated to point to nowhere.
4086
4087 +++
4088 *** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
4089 variable `sentence-end-without-space', which contains such characters
4090 that end a sentence without following spaces.
4091
4092 The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of the
4093 variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil, then
4094 this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
4095 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
4096 `sentence-end-without-space'.
4097
4098 ** Undo changes:
4099
4100 +++
4101 *** `buffer-undo-list' can allows programmable elements.
4102
4103 These elements have the form (apply FUNNAME . ARGS), where FUNNAME is
4104 a symbol other than t or nil. That stands for a high-level change
4105 that should be undone by evaluating (apply FUNNAME ARGS).
4106
4107 These entries can also have the form (apply DELTA BEG END FUNNAME . ARGS)
4108 which indicates that the change which took place was limited to the
4109 range BEG...END and increased the buffer size by DELTA.
4110
4111 +++
4112 *** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
4113 `undo-outer-limit', garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
4114 it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
4115
4116 +++
4117 ** New `yank-handler' text property can be used to control how
4118 previously killed text on the kill ring is reinserted.
4119
4120 The value of the `yank-handler' property must be a list with one to four
4121 elements with the following format:
4122 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
4123
4124 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
4125 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
4126 element on the kill-ring). If a `yank-handler' property is found,
4127 the normal behavior of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
4128
4129 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
4130 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
4131 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
4132 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
4133 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
4134 rectangle.
4135 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
4136 `yank-excluded-properties' is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
4137 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
4138 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
4139 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
4140 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
4141 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
4142 FUNCTION can set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
4143
4144 *** The functions `kill-new', `kill-append', and `kill-region' now have an
4145 optional argument to specify the `yank-handler' text property to put on
4146 the killed text.
4147
4148 *** The function `yank-pop' will now use a non-nil value of the variable
4149 `yank-undo-function' (instead of `delete-region') to undo the previous
4150 `yank' or `yank-pop' command (or a call to `insert-for-yank'). The function
4151 `insert-for-yank' automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
4152 element of the string argument's `yank-handler' text property if present.
4153
4154 *** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
4155 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
4156 string. The old behavior is available if you call
4157 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
4158
4159 ** Syntax table changes:
4160
4161 +++
4162 *** The macro `with-syntax-table' no longer copies the syntax table.
4163
4164 +++
4165 *** The new function `syntax-after' returns the syntax code
4166 of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
4167 of text properties as well as the character code.
4168
4169 +++
4170 *** `syntax-class' extracts the class of a syntax code (as returned
4171 by `syntax-after').
4172
4173 +++
4174 *** The new function `syntax-ppss' provides an efficient way to find the
4175 current syntactic context at point.
4176
4177 ** File operation changes:
4178
4179 +++
4180 *** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
4181 searching for an executable or an Emacs Lisp file.
4182
4183 +++
4184 *** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
4185 modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
4186 operation.
4187
4188 +++
4189 *** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
4190 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
4191 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
4192 The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
4193
4194 +++
4195 *** `buffer-auto-save-file-format' is the new name for what was
4196 formerly called `auto-save-file-format'. It is now a permanent local.
4197
4198 +++
4199 *** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
4200 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
4201 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
4202
4203 +++
4204 *** `copy-file' now takes an additional option arg MUSTBENEW.
4205
4206 This argument works like the MUSTBENEW argument of write-file.
4207
4208 +++
4209 *** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
4210 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
4211
4212 +++
4213 *** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
4214 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
4215 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
4216 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
4217
4218 +++
4219 *** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
4220 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
4221 tasks. For example, it can be used by the copyright package to make
4222 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
4223
4224 +++
4225 *** If `buffer-save-without-query' is non-nil in some buffer,
4226 `save-some-buffers' will always save that buffer without asking (if
4227 it's modified).
4228
4229 +++
4230 *** New function `locate-file' searches for a file in a list of directories.
4231 `locate-file' accepts a name of a file to search (a string), and two
4232 lists: a list of directories to search in and a list of suffixes to
4233 try; typical usage might use `exec-path' and `load-path' for the list
4234 of directories, and `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' for the list
4235 of suffixes. The function also accepts a predicate argument to
4236 further filter candidate files.
4237
4238 One advantage of using this function is that the list of suffixes in
4239 `exec-suffixes' is OS-dependant, so this function will find
4240 executables without polluting Lisp code with OS dependencies.
4241
4242 ---
4243 *** The precedence of file name handlers has been changed.
4244
4245 Instead of choosing the first handler that matches,
4246 `find-file-name-handler' now gives precedence to a file name handler
4247 that matches nearest the end of the file name. More precisely, the
4248 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen. In case
4249 of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
4250
4251 +++
4252 *** A file name handler can declare which operations it handles.
4253
4254 You do this by putting an `operation' property on the handler name
4255 symbol. The property value should be a list of the operations that
4256 the handler really handles. It won't be called for any other
4257 operations.
4258
4259 This is useful for autoloaded handlers, to prevent them from being
4260 autoloaded when not really necessary.
4261
4262 +++
4263 *** The function `make-auto-save-file-name' is now handled by file
4264 name handlers. This will be exploited for remote files mainly.
4265
4266 ** Input changes:
4267
4268 +++
4269 *** An interactive specification can now use the code letter 'U' to get
4270 the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
4271 previous `k' or `K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
4272
4273 +++
4274 *** The new interactive-specification `G' reads a file name
4275 much like `F', but if the input is a directory name (even defaulted),
4276 it returns just the directory name.
4277
4278 ---
4279 *** Functions `y-or-n-p', `read-char', `read-key-sequence' and the like, that
4280 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
4281 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
4282
4283 +++
4284 *** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
4285 arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
4286 quit had occurred. `while-no-input' returns the value of BODY, if BODY
4287 finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted by a quit, and t if
4288 BODY was aborted by arrival of input.
4289
4290 ** Minibuffer changes:
4291
4292 +++
4293 *** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional
4294 buffer argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted, it
4295 defaults to the current buffer.
4296
4297 +++
4298 *** New function `minibuffer-selected-window' returns the window which
4299 was selected when entering the minibuffer.
4300
4301 +++
4302 *** `read-from-minibuffer' now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
4303 saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
4304
4305 +++
4306 *** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
4307 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satisfy. The
4308 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
4309 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
4310 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
4311
4312 ---
4313 *** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by Lisp code
4314 to override the built-in `read-file-name' function.
4315
4316 +++
4317 *** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
4318 whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
4319 `read-file-name' function.
4320
4321 +++
4322 *** The new function `read-directory-name' is for reading a directory name.
4323
4324 It is like `read-file-name' except that the defaulting works better
4325 for directories, and completion inside it shows only directories.
4326
4327 ** Completion changes:
4328
4329 +++
4330 *** The new function `minibuffer-completion-contents' returns the contents
4331 of the minibuffer just before point. That is what completion commands
4332 operate on.
4333
4334 +++
4335 *** The functions `all-completions' and `try-completion' now accept lists
4336 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
4337 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
4338 exported to Lisp. The keys in alists and hash tables can be either
4339 strings or symbols, which are automatically converted with to strings.
4340
4341 +++
4342 *** The new macro `dynamic-completion-table' supports using functions
4343 as a dynamic completion table.
4344
4345 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
4346
4347 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
4348 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
4349 completions. This alist can be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
4350 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
4351 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
4352 entered. `dynamic-completion-table' then computes the completion.
4353
4354 +++
4355 *** The new macro `lazy-completion-table' initializes a variable
4356 as a lazy completion table.
4357
4358 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN)
4359
4360 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
4361 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with no
4362 arguments. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR.
4363 If completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
4364 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
4365 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
4366
4367 +++
4368 ** Enhancements to keymaps.
4369
4370 *** New keymaps for typing file names
4371
4372 Two new keymaps, `minibuffer-local-filename-completion-map' and
4373 `minibuffer-local-must-match-filename-map', apply whenever
4374 Emacs reads a file name in the minibuffer. These key maps override
4375 the usual binding of SPC to `minibuffer-complete-word' (so that file
4376 names with embedded spaces could be typed without the need to quote
4377 the spaces).
4378
4379 *** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
4380
4381 You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
4382 same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
4383 example,
4384
4385 (kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
4386
4387 *** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
4388
4389 This is an alternative to using `defadvice' or `substitute-key-definition'
4390 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
4391 binding and lookup functionality.
4392
4393 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
4394 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
4395 original command.
4396
4397 Example:
4398 Suppose that minor mode `my-mode' has defined the commands
4399 `my-kill-line' and `my-kill-word', and it wants C-k (and any other key
4400 bound to `kill-line') to run the command `my-kill-line' instead of
4401 `kill-line', and likewise it wants to run `my-kill-word' instead of
4402 `kill-word'.
4403
4404 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
4405 command remapping allows you to directly map `kill-line' into
4406 `my-kill-line' and `kill-word' into `my-kill-word' using `define-key':
4407
4408 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
4409 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
4410
4411 When `my-mode' is enabled, its minor mode keymap is enabled too. So
4412 when the user types C-k, that runs the command `my-kill-line'.
4413
4414 Only one level of remapping is supported. In the above example, this
4415 means that if `my-kill-line' is remapped to `other-kill', then C-k still
4416 runs `my-kill-line'.
4417
4418 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
4419
4420 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
4421 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
4422 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
4423 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
4424
4425 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
4426 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
4427
4428 - `key-binding' now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
4429 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
4430
4431 - `where-is-internal' now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
4432 `kill-line', when `my-mode' is enabled), and the actual key binding for
4433 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
4434 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
4435 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns "C-k" for `kill-line', and
4436 "<kill-line>" for `my-kill-line').
4437
4438 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
4439 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
4440 command was not remapped.
4441
4442 *** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
4443 over minor mode keymaps.
4444
4445 *** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
4446 text properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
4447 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
4448
4449 *** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
4450
4451 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
4452 bindings of the parent keymap.
4453
4454 *** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
4455
4456 *** New function `current-active-maps' returns a list of currently
4457 active keymaps.
4458
4459 *** New function `describe-buffer-bindings' inserts the list of all
4460 defined keys and their definitions.
4461
4462 *** New function `keymap-prompt' returns the prompt string of a keymap.
4463
4464 *** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
4465 in the keymap.
4466
4467 *** New variable `emulation-mode-map-alists'.
4468
4469 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
4470 keymap alist separate from `minor-mode-map-alist' by adding their
4471 keymap alist to this list.
4472
4473 ** Abbrev changes:
4474
4475 +++
4476 *** The new function `copy-abbrev-table' copies an abbrev table.
4477
4478 It returns a new abbrev table that is a copy of a given abbrev table.
4479
4480 +++
4481 *** `define-abbrev' now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG.
4482
4483 If non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means
4484 that it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the
4485 abbrevs. Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always
4486 specify this flag.
4487
4488 +++
4489 ** Enhancements to process support
4490
4491 *** Function `list-processes' now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
4492 it lists only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set.
4493
4494 *** New fns `set-process-query-on-exit-flag' and `process-query-on-exit-flag'.
4495
4496 These replace the old function `process-kill-without-query'. That
4497 function is still supported, but new code should use the new
4498 functions.
4499
4500 *** Function `signal-process' now accepts a process object or process
4501 name in addition to a process id to identify the signaled process.
4502
4503 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
4504 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
4505
4506 Use the new functions `process-get' and `process-put' to access, add,
4507 and modify elements on this property list. Use the new functions
4508 `process-plist' and `set-process-plist' to access and replace the
4509 entire property list of a process.
4510
4511 *** Function `accept-process-output' has a new optional fourth arg
4512 JUST-THIS-ONE. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
4513 is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
4514 integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
4515 recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
4516 speech synthesis.
4517
4518 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
4519
4520 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
4521 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
4522 very poor performance. This behavior can be remedied to some extent
4523 by setting the new variable `process-adaptive-read-buffering' to a
4524 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
4525 from such processes, allowing them to produce more output before
4526 emacs tries to read it.
4527
4528 *** The new function `call-process-shell-command'.
4529
4530 This executes a shell command synchronously in a separate process.
4531
4532 *** The new function `process-file' is similar to `call-process', but
4533 obeys file handlers. The file handler is chosen based on
4534 `default-directory'.
4535
4536 *** A process filter function gets the output as multibyte string
4537 if the process specifies t for its filter's multibyteness.
4538
4539 That multibyteness is decided by the value of
4540 `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is created, and
4541 you can change it later with `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
4542
4543 *** The new function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the
4544 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4545
4546 *** The new function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns the
4547 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4548
4549 *** If a process's coding system is `raw-text' or `no-conversion' and its
4550 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
4551 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
4552 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
4553 which was not compatible with the behavior of file reading.
4554
4555 +++
4556 ** Enhanced networking support.
4557
4558 *** The new `make-network-process' function makes network connections.
4559 It allows opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
4560 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
4561
4562 - A server is started using :server t arg.
4563 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
4564 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
4565 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
4566 - IPv6 is supported (when available). You may explicitly select IPv6
4567 using :family 'ipv6 arg.
4568 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
4569 - The process' property list can be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
4570 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
4571 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
4572
4573 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
4574 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
4575 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:family ipv6))
4576
4577 *** The old `open-network-stream' now uses `make-network-process'.
4578
4579 *** New functions `process-datagram-address', `set-process-datagram-address'.
4580
4581 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
4582 and set the current address of the remote partner.
4583
4584 *** New function `format-network-address'.
4585
4586 This function reformats the Lisp representation of a network address
4587 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
4588 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
4589 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
4590 string for other formatting options.
4591
4592 *** `process-contact' has an optional KEY argument.
4593
4594 Depending on this argument, you can get the complete list of network
4595 process properties or a specific property. Using :local or :remote as
4596 the KEY, you get the address of the local or remote end-point.
4597
4598 An Inet address is represented as a 5 element vector, where the first
4599 4 elements contain the IP address and the fifth is the port number.
4600
4601 *** New functions `stop-process' and `continue-process'.
4602
4603 These functions stop and restart communication through a network
4604 connection. For a server process, no connections are accepted in the
4605 stopped state. For a client process, no input is received in the
4606 stopped state.
4607
4608 *** New function `network-interface-list'.
4609
4610 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
4611 current network addresses.
4612
4613 *** New function `network-interface-info'.
4614
4615 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
4616 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
4617
4618 *** Deleting a network process with `delete-process' calls the sentinel.
4619
4620 The status message passed to the sentinel for a deleted network
4621 process is "deleted". The message passed to the sentinel when the
4622 connection is closed by the remote peer has been changed to
4623 "connection broken by remote peer".
4624
4625 ** Using window objects:
4626
4627 +++
4628 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4629
4630 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line or the
4631 header line.
4632
4633 +++
4634 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4635
4636 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line
4637 or the header line.
4638
4639 +++
4640 *** You can now make a window as short as one line.
4641
4642 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
4643 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
4644 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
4645 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
4646 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
4647
4648 +++
4649 *** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
4650 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
4651 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
4652 the mode line.
4653
4654 +++
4655 *** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
4656 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
4657
4658 +++
4659 *** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
4660 selected window without impacting the order of `buffer-list'.
4661 It saves and restores the current buffer, too.
4662
4663 +++
4664 *** `select-window' takes an optional second argument NORECORD.
4665
4666 This is like `switch-to-buffer'.
4667
4668 +++
4669 *** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
4670 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
4671 by calling `select-window'. It also saves and restores the current
4672 buffer.
4673
4674 +++
4675 *** `set-window-buffer' has an optional argument KEEP-MARGINS.
4676
4677 If non-nil, that says to preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
4678 and scroll-bar settings.
4679
4680 +++
4681 *** The new function `window-tree' returns a frame's window tree.
4682
4683 +++
4684 *** The functions `get-lru-window' and `get-largest-window' take an optional
4685 argument `dedicated'. If non-nil, those functions do not ignore
4686 dedicated windows.
4687
4688 +++
4689 *** The new function `adjust-window-trailing-edge' moves the right
4690 or bottom edge of a window. It does not move other window edges.
4691
4692 +++
4693 ** Customizable fringe bitmaps
4694
4695 *** New buffer-local variables `fringe-indicator-alist' and
4696 `fringe-cursor-alist' maps between logical (internal) fringe indicator
4697 and cursor symbols and the actual fringe bitmaps to be displayed.
4698 This decouples the logical meaning of the fringe indicators from the
4699 physical appearance, as well as allowing different fringe bitmaps to
4700 be used in different windows showing different buffers.
4701
4702 *** New function `define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
4703 fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
4704
4705 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
4706 identifying the bitmap such as `left-truncation' or `continued-line'.
4707
4708 *** New function `destroy-fringe-bitmap' deletes a fringe bitmap
4709 or restores a built-in one to its default value.
4710
4711 *** New function `set-fringe-bitmap-face' specifies the face to be
4712 used for a specific fringe bitmap. The face is automatically merged
4713 with the `fringe' face, so normally, the face should only specify the
4714 foreground color of the bitmap.
4715
4716 *** There are new display properties, `left-fringe' and `right-fringe',
4717 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
4718 bitmap of the display line.
4719
4720 Format is `display (left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])', where BITMAP is a
4721 symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
4722 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
4723 for displaying the bitmap instead of the default `fringe' face.
4724 When specified, FACE is automatically merged with the `fringe' face.
4725
4726 *** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
4727 bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
4728
4729 ** Other window fringe features:
4730
4731 +++
4732 *** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
4733
4734 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
4735 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
4736 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
4737 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
4738
4739 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
4740 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
4741 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
4742 between the left and right fringe. To force a specific fringe width,
4743 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
4744 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
4745
4746 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
4747 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
4748 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
4749 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
4750
4751 +++
4752 *** Per-window fringe and scrollbar settings
4753
4754 **** Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and
4755 position settings.
4756
4757 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
4758 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
4759 `set-window-fringes'.
4760
4761 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
4762 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
4763 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
4764 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
4765
4766 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
4767 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
4768 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
4769 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
4770 an update of the display margins.
4771
4772 **** Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
4773 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
4774
4775 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
4776 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
4777 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
4778 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
4779 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
4780 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
4781 of the display margins.
4782
4783 ** Redisplay features:
4784
4785 +++
4786 *** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
4787
4788 +++
4789 *** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
4790 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
4791 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
4792 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
4793 forcing an explicit window update.
4794
4795 +++
4796 *** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
4797 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
4798 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
4799
4800 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
4801 does that, this value cannot be accurate.
4802
4803 +++
4804 *** You can define multiple overlay arrows via the new
4805 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'.
4806
4807 It contains a list of variables which contain overlay arrow position
4808 markers, including the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
4809
4810 Each variable on this list can have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
4811 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
4812 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
4813 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
4814 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
4815 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
4816
4817 +++
4818 *** New `line-height' and `line-spacing' properties for newline characters
4819
4820 A newline can now have `line-height' and `line-spacing' text or overlay
4821 properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
4822
4823 If the `line-height' property value is t, the newline does not
4824 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
4825 newline glyph is reduced. Also, a `line-spacing' property on this
4826 newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
4827 slices without adding blank areas between the images.
4828
4829 If the `line-height' property value is a positive integer, the value
4830 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
4831 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
4832
4833 If the `line-height' property value is a float, the minimum line
4834 height is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by
4835 the given value.
4836
4837 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (FACE . RATIO), the
4838 minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
4839 RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
4840
4841 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (nil . RATIO), the line
4842 height is calculated as RATIO * actual height of the line's contents.
4843
4844 If the `line-height' value is a cons (HEIGHT . TOTAL), HEIGHT specifies
4845 the line height as described above, while TOTAL is any of the forms
4846 described above and specifies the total height of the line, causing a
4847 varying number of pixels to be inserted after the line to make it line
4848 exactly that many pixels high.
4849
4850 If the `line-spacing' property value is an positive integer, the value
4851 is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
4852 overrides the default frame `line-spacing' and any buffer local value of
4853 the `line-spacing' variable.
4854
4855 If the `line-spacing' property is a float or cons, the line spacing
4856 is calculated as specified above for the `line-height' property.
4857
4858 +++
4859 *** The buffer local `line-spacing' variable can now have a float value,
4860 which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
4861
4862 +++
4863 *** Enhancements to stretch display properties
4864
4865 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
4866 PROPS is a property list, now allows pixel based width and height
4867 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
4868
4869 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
4870 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
4871 are supported:
4872
4873 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
4874 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
4875 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
4876 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
4877 | scroll-bar | text
4878 POS ::= left | center | right
4879 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
4880 OP ::= + | -
4881
4882 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
4883 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
4884 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
4885 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
4886 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
4887 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
4888 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
4889 the image.
4890
4891 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
4892 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
4893 corresponding area of the window.
4894
4895 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
4896 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
4897 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
4898 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
4899 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
4900 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
4901 these symbols), further occurrences of these symbols are interpreted as
4902 the width of the area.
4903
4904 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
4905 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
4906
4907 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
4908 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
4909 header line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
4910
4911 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
4912 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
4913 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
4914 height) of the specified image.
4915
4916 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
4917 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
4918
4919 +++
4920 *** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
4921 text property string that may be present at the current window
4922 position. The cursor can now be placed on any character of such
4923 strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
4924
4925 +++
4926 *** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
4927 supported on text terminals.
4928
4929 +++
4930 *** Support for displaying image slices
4931
4932 **** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) can be used with
4933 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
4934
4935 **** Function `insert-image' has new optional fourth arg to
4936 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
4937
4938 **** New function `insert-sliced-image' inserts a given image as a
4939 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
4940
4941 +++
4942 *** Images can now have an associated image map via the :map property.
4943
4944 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
4945 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
4946 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((X0 . Y0) . (X1 . Y1))) specifying the
4947 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
4948 A circle is a cons (circle . ((X0 . Y0) . R)) specifying the center
4949 and the radius of the circle; R can be a float or integer.
4950 A polygon is a cons (poly . [X0 Y0 X1 Y1 ...]) where each pair in the
4951 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
4952
4953 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
4954 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
4955 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
4956 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
4957 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable `void-area-text-pointer'
4958 for possible pointer shapes.
4959
4960 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
4961 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
4962 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
4963
4964 +++
4965 *** The function `find-image' now searches in etc/images/ and etc/.
4966 The new variable `image-load-path' is a list of locations in which to
4967 search for image files. The default is to search in etc/images, then
4968 in etc/, and finally in the directories specified by `load-path'.
4969 Subdirectories of etc/ and etc/images are not recursively searched; if
4970 you put an image file in a subdirectory, you have to specify it
4971 explicitly; for example, if an image is put in etc/images/foo/bar.xpm:
4972
4973 (defimage foo-image '((:type xpm :file "foo/bar.xpm")))
4974
4975 Note that all images formerly located in the lisp directory have been
4976 moved to etc/images.
4977
4978 +++
4979 *** New function `image-load-path-for-library' returns a suitable
4980 search path for images relative to library. This function is useful in
4981 external packages to save users from having to update
4982 `image-load-path'.
4983
4984 +++
4985 *** The new variable `max-image-size' defines the maximum size of
4986 images that Emacs will load and display.
4987
4988 ** Mouse pointer features:
4989
4990 +++ (lispref)
4991 ??? (man)
4992 *** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
4993 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
4994 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
4995 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
4996 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
4997
4998 +++
4999 *** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
5000 :pointer image property.
5001
5002 +++
5003 *** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images can now be
5004 controlled/overridden via the `pointer' text property.
5005
5006 ** Mouse event enhancements:
5007
5008 +++
5009 *** Mouse events for clicks on window fringes now specify `left-fringe'
5010 or `right-fringe' as the area.
5011
5012 +++
5013 *** All mouse events now include a buffer position regardless of where
5014 you clicked. For mouse clicks in window margins and fringes, this is
5015 a sensible buffer position corresponding to the surrounding text.
5016
5017 +++
5018 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
5019
5020 +++
5021 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
5022
5023 +++
5024 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
5025 text area).
5026
5027 +++
5028 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types
5029 and all areas.
5030
5031 +++
5032 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns the actual glyph coordinates
5033 of the mouse event position.
5034
5035 +++
5036 *** Mouse events can now indicate an image object clicked on.
5037
5038 +++
5039 *** Mouse events include relative X and Y pixel coordinates relative to
5040 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
5041
5042 +++
5043 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
5044 (image or character) clicked on.
5045
5046 +++
5047 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', 'posn-object-width-height'.
5048
5049 These return the image or string object of a mouse click, the X and Y
5050 pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner of that object, and
5051 the total width and height of that object.
5052
5053 ** Text property and overlay changes:
5054
5055 +++
5056 *** Arguments for `remove-overlays' are now optional, so that you can
5057 remove all overlays in the buffer with just (remove-overlays).
5058
5059 +++
5060 *** New variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
5061
5062 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
5063 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
5064 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
5065 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
5066
5067 +++
5068 *** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
5069 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
5070 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
5071 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
5072 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
5073
5074 +++
5075 *** The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties'.
5076
5077 It is like `remove-text-properties' except that it takes a list of
5078 property names as argument rather than a property list.
5079
5080 ** Face changes
5081
5082 +++
5083 *** The new face attribute condition `min-colors' can be used to tailor
5084 the face color to the number of colors supported by a display, and
5085 define the foreground and background colors accordingly so that they
5086 look best on a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This
5087 is now the preferred method for defining default faces in a way that
5088 makes a good use of the capabilities of the display.
5089
5090 +++
5091 *** New function `display-supports-face-attributes-p' can be used to test
5092 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
5093
5094 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
5095 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
5096 defined with `defface'.
5097
5098 ---
5099 *** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
5100 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
5101 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
5102 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
5103 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
5104
5105 +++
5106 *** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
5107 `default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
5108 defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and can be overridden
5109 by them).
5110
5111 +++
5112 *** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
5113 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
5114 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
5115 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
5116 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
5117
5118 ---
5119 *** The function `face-differs-from-default-p' now truly checks
5120 whether the given face displays differently from the default face or
5121 not (previously it did only a very cursory check).
5122
5123 +++
5124 *** `face-attribute', `face-foreground', `face-background', `face-stipple'.
5125
5126 These now accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how
5127 face inheritance is used when determining the value of a face
5128 attribute.
5129
5130 +++
5131 *** New functions `face-attribute-relative-p' and `merge-face-attribute'
5132 help with handling relative face attributes.
5133
5134 +++
5135 *** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face list is reversed.
5136
5137 If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
5138 faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous
5139 releases of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made
5140 so that :inherit face lists operate identically to face lists in text
5141 `face' properties.
5142
5143 ---
5144 *** On terminals, faces with the :inverse-video attribute are displayed
5145 with swapped foreground and background colors even when one of them is
5146 not specified. In previous releases of Emacs, if either foreground
5147 or background color was unspecified, colors were not swapped. This
5148 was inconsistent with the face behavior under X.
5149
5150 ---
5151 *** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
5152 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
5153
5154 ** Font-Lock changes:
5155
5156 +++
5157 *** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
5158
5159 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
5160 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
5161 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
5162 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
5163
5164 +++
5165 *** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
5166
5167 **** the FACENAME returned in `font-lock-keywords' can be a list of the
5168 form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set other
5169 properties than `face'.
5170
5171 **** `font-lock-extra-managed-props' can be set to make sure those
5172 extra properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
5173
5174 ---
5175 *** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
5176
5177 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
5178 (see `jit-lock-defer-contextually'), then all of that text will
5179 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
5180 depends on text several lines further down (and when `font-lock-multiline'
5181 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
5182
5183 s{
5184 foo
5185 }{
5186 bar
5187 }e
5188
5189 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
5190 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a `jit-lock-defer-multiline'
5191 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
5192 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
5193
5194 ** Major mode mechanism changes:
5195
5196 +++
5197 *** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
5198 precedence over the file name. Likewise an `<?xml' or `<!DOCTYPE'
5199 declaration will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new
5200 variable `magic-mode-alist'.
5201
5202 +++
5203 *** Use the new function `run-mode-hooks' to run the major mode's mode hook.
5204
5205 +++
5206 *** All major mode functions should now run the new normal hook
5207 `after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode
5208 hooks. `run-mode-hooks' does this automatically.
5209
5210 ---
5211 *** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
5212 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
5213 it in that buffer.
5214
5215 +++
5216 *** Major modes can define `eldoc-documentation-function'
5217 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
5218 the language.
5219
5220 +++
5221 *** `define-derived-mode' by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
5222 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
5223
5224 +++
5225 *** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
5226 are used by `define-derived-mode' to make sure the mode hook for the
5227 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
5228
5229 ** Minor mode changes:
5230
5231 +++
5232 *** `define-minor-mode' now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
5233 and simply passes them to `defcustom', if applicable.
5234
5235 +++
5236 *** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
5237
5238 +++
5239 *** `define-global-minor-mode'.
5240
5241 This is a new name for what was formerly called
5242 `easy-mmode-define-global-mode'. The old name remains as an alias.
5243
5244 ** Command loop changes:
5245
5246 +++
5247 *** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
5248 have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' to do: it returns t if the
5249 calling function was called through `call-interactively'.
5250
5251 Only use this when you cannot solve the problem by adding a new
5252 INTERACTIVE argument to the command.
5253
5254 +++
5255 *** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional argument.
5256
5257 If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks for a function that could be
5258 called with `call-interactively', and does not return t for keyboard
5259 macros.
5260
5261 +++
5262 *** When a command returns, the command loop moves point out from
5263 within invisible text, in the same way it moves out from within text
5264 covered by an image or composition property.
5265
5266 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
5267 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
5268 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
5269 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
5270 `post-command-hook' and thus does not care about intermediate states.
5271
5272 +++
5273 *** If a command sets `transient-mark-mode' to `only', that
5274 enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
5275 During that following command, the value of `transient-mark-mode'
5276 is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
5277 the next return to the command loop changes to nil.
5278
5279 +++
5280 *** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
5281 been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
5282 `disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
5283
5284 +++
5285 *** `emacsserver' now runs `pre-command-hook' and `post-command-hook'
5286 when it receives a request from emacsclient.
5287
5288 ** Lisp file loading changes:
5289
5290 +++
5291 *** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
5292 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
5293 current file redefined it).
5294
5295 +++
5296 *** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
5297 defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
5298
5299 +++
5300 *** The function `symbol-file' can now search specifically for function,
5301 variable or face definitions.
5302
5303 +++
5304 *** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
5305 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
5306 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
5307
5308 ---
5309 *** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
5310 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
5311 than 3 levels of nesting.
5312
5313 +++
5314 ** Byte compiler changes:
5315
5316 *** The byte compiler now displays the actual line and character
5317 position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form of its
5318 warning and error messages have been brought into line with GNU standards
5319 for these. As a result, you can use next-error and friends on the
5320 compilation output buffer.
5321
5322 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
5323 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
5324
5325 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
5326 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
5327 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
5328 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
5329 forms:
5330
5331 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
5332 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
5333
5334 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
5335 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
5336 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
5337 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
5338 macro expansion), but such tests can be nested. Note that `when' and
5339 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
5340
5341 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
5342 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
5343 Emacs and XEmacs and can sometimes make the result significantly more
5344 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
5345 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
5346 you anything.
5347
5348 *** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in Lisp files is now obeyed.
5349
5350 ---
5351 *** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
5352 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
5353 (require 'cl) when loaded.
5354
5355 ** Frame operations:
5356
5357 +++
5358 *** New functions `frame-current-scroll-bars' and `window-current-scroll-bars'.
5359
5360 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
5361 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
5362
5363 +++
5364 *** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
5365 for all (existing and future) frames.
5366
5367 +++
5368 *** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
5369 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
5370 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
5371 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
5372
5373 +++
5374 *** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
5375 the `scroll-bar-width' frame parameter value is nil.
5376
5377 ** Mule changes:
5378
5379 +++
5380 *** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
5381
5382 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
5383 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
5384 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
5385 now:
5386
5387 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
5388
5389 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
5390 the time it takes to convert the format.
5391
5392 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
5393 wasteful.
5394
5395 ---
5396 *** `set-buffer-file-coding-system' now takes an additional argument,
5397 NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
5398
5399 +++
5400 *** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
5401 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
5402 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
5403 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
5404
5405 ---
5406 *** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
5407 of one coding system from another coding system.
5408
5409 ---
5410 *** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
5411 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
5412 parts, e.g. utf-16.
5413
5414 +++
5415 *** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
5416 it is read from a file without decoding.
5417
5418 ---
5419 *** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
5420 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
5421
5422 ---
5423 *** New function `quail-find-key' returns a list of keys to type in the
5424 current input method to input a character.
5425
5426 ** Mode line changes:
5427
5428 +++
5429 *** New function `format-mode-line'.
5430
5431 This returns the mode line or header line of the selected (or a
5432 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
5433
5434 +++
5435 *** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
5436 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
5437
5438 +++
5439 *** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
5440 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
5441 line.
5442
5443 +++
5444 *** Mouse-face on mode-line (and header-line) is now supported.
5445
5446 ** Menu manipulation changes:
5447
5448 ---
5449 *** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
5450 proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
5451 "files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
5452 several versions ago.
5453
5454 ---
5455 *** The dummy function keys made by easy-menu are now always lower case.
5456 If you specify the menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
5457 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
5458
5459 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for the bindings that were
5460 made with easy-menu.
5461
5462 ---
5463 *** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
5464 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
5465 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
5466 need to have a name.
5467
5468 ** Operating system access:
5469
5470 +++
5471 *** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
5472 run time used by Emacs since start-up.
5473
5474 +++
5475 *** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
5476 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
5477 accepts a float as UID parameter.
5478
5479 +++
5480 *** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
5481
5482 ---
5483 *** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
5484 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
5485 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
5486
5487 ---
5488 *** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
5489 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
5490
5491 ** Miscellaneous:
5492
5493 +++
5494 *** A number of hooks have been renamed to better follow the conventions:
5495
5496 `find-file-hooks' to `find-file-hook',
5497 `find-file-not-found-hooks' to `find-file-not-found-functions',
5498 `write-file-hooks' to `write-file-functions',
5499 `write-contents-hooks' to `write-contents-functions',
5500 `x-lost-selection-hooks' to `x-lost-selection-functions',
5501 `x-sent-selection-hooks' to `x-sent-selection-functions',
5502 `delete-frame-hook' to `delete-frame-functions'.
5503
5504 In each case the old name remains as an alias for the moment.
5505
5506 +++
5507 *** Variable `local-write-file-hooks' is marked obsolete.
5508
5509 Use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook'.
5510
5511 ---
5512 *** New function `x-send-client-message' sends a client message when
5513 running under X.
5514
5515 ** GC changes:
5516
5517 +++
5518 *** New variable `gc-cons-percentage' automatically grows the GC cons threshold
5519 as the heap size increases.
5520
5521 +++
5522 *** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
5523 on garbage collection.
5524
5525 +++
5526 *** The normal hook `post-gc-hook' is run at the end of garbage collection.
5527
5528 The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
5529 \f
5530 * New Packages for Lisp Programming in Emacs 22.1
5531
5532 +++
5533 ** The new library button.el implements simple and fast `clickable
5534 buttons' in emacs buffers. Buttons are much lighter-weight than the
5535 `widgets' implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that
5536 doesn't require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for
5537 such things as help and apropos buffers.
5538
5539 ---
5540 ** The new library tree-widget.el provides a widget to display a set
5541 of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
5542 well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
5543
5544 +++
5545 ** The new library bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
5546 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
5547 data structures.
5548
5549 ---
5550 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
5551 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
5552
5553 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
5554 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
5555 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
5556 commands.
5557
5558 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
5559 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
5560 SQL buffer.
5561
5562 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
5563 (function (lambda ()
5564 (master-mode t)
5565 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5566 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
5567 (function (lambda ()
5568 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5569
5570 +++
5571 ** The new library benchmark.el does timing measurements on Lisp code.
5572
5573 This includes measuring garbage collection time.
5574
5575 +++
5576 ** The new library testcover.el does test coverage checking.
5577
5578 This is so you can tell whether you've tested all paths in your Lisp
5579 code. It works with edebug.
5580
5581 The function `testcover-start' instruments all functions in a given
5582 file. Then test your code. The function `testcover-mark-all' adds
5583 overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to show where coverage
5584 is lacking. The command `testcover-next-mark' (bind it to a key!)
5585 will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
5586
5587 Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely
5588 evaluated; a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same
5589 value. The red splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly
5590 complete their evaluation, such as `error'. The brown splotches are
5591 skipped for forms that are expected to always evaluate to the same
5592 value, such as (setq x 14).
5593
5594 For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to
5595 help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a
5596 red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does
5597 return. The macro `1value' suppresses a brown splotch for its argument.
5598 This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals
5599 an error if the argument actually returns differing values.
5600 \f
5601 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
5602
5603 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
5604 been added.
5605
5606 \f
5607 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
5608
5609 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
5610 with Custom.
5611
5612 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
5613 as mule-utf-8.
5614
5615 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
5616 in UTF-8 locales).
5617
5618 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
5619 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
5620 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
5621 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
5622 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
5623 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
5624 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
5625 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
5626 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
5627 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
5628
5629 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
5630 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
5631
5632 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
5633 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
5634 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
5635 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
5636 contrary to the compound text specification.
5637
5638 \f
5639 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
5640
5641 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
5642
5643 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
5644
5645 \f
5646 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
5647
5648 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
5649
5650 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
5651 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
5652 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
5653 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
5654 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
5655
5656 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
5657 were changed.
5658
5659 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
5660 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
5661
5662 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
5663 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
5664 instead of using default-major-mode.
5665
5666 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
5667 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
5668 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
5669 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
5670 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
5671 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
5672 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
5673
5674 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
5675 NEWS.
5676
5677 \f
5678 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
5679
5680 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
5681 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
5682 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
5683
5684 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
5685 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
5686
5687 \f
5688 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
5689
5690 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
5691 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
5692 charsets in this release.
5693
5694 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
5695
5696 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
5697
5698 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
5699 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
5700 to list them.
5701
5702 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
5703 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
5704 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
5705 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
5706 necessary changes to unexec.
5707
5708 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
5709 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
5710
5711 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
5712 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
5713
5714 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
5715 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
5716
5717 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
5718 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
5719 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
5720 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
5721 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
5722
5723 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
5724 new display features described below.
5725
5726 \f
5727 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
5728
5729 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
5730
5731 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
5732 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
5733 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
5734 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
5735 the text.
5736
5737 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
5738
5739 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
5740 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
5741 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
5742 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
5743 specify a font.
5744
5745 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
5746 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
5747 under Lisp changes, below.
5748
5749 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
5750
5751 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
5752 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
5753 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
5754 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
5755 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
5756 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
5757 on terminals.
5758
5759 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
5760 supported on character terminals.
5761
5762 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
5763 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
5764 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
5765 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
5766
5767 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
5768
5769 ** Sound support
5770
5771 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
5772 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
5773 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
5774 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
5775 sound support.
5776
5777 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
5778
5779 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
5780 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
5781 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
5782 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
5783
5784 - User option: max-mini-window-height
5785
5786 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
5787 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
5788 specifies a number of lines.
5789
5790 Default is 0.25.
5791
5792 - User option: resize-mini-windows
5793
5794 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
5795 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
5796 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
5797 again.
5798
5799 Default is `grow-only'.
5800
5801 ** LessTif support.
5802
5803 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
5804 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
5805
5806 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
5807
5808 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
5809 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
5810 non-nil.
5811
5812 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
5813
5814 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
5815 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
5816 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
5817
5818 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
5819
5820 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
5821 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
5822 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
5823 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
5824 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
5825 Emacs.
5826
5827 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
5828 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
5829 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
5830 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
5831 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
5832 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
5833
5834 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
5835 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
5836 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
5837 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
5838 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
5839 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
5840
5841 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
5842 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
5843 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
5844 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
5845 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
5846
5847 ** Tool bar support.
5848
5849 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
5850 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
5851 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
5852 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
5853 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
5854 icons will be used.
5855
5856 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
5857 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
5858
5859 ** Tooltips.
5860
5861 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
5862 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
5863 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
5864
5865 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
5866 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
5867 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
5868 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
5869
5870 ** Automatic Hscrolling
5871
5872 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
5873 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
5874 customized.
5875
5876 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
5877 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
5878 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
5879 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
5880 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
5881
5882 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
5883 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
5884 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
5885 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
5886 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
5887 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
5888
5889 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
5890 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
5891 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
5892 customizing face `fringe'.
5893
5894 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
5895 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
5896 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
5897 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
5898 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
5899 the window to be partially obscured.)
5900
5901 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
5902 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
5903 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
5904 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
5905
5906 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
5907
5908 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
5909 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
5910 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
5911 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
5912 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
5913 have enabled one.
5914
5915 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
5916
5917 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
5918
5919 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
5920
5921 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
5922 `*') toggles the status.
5923
5924 - Mouse-3 on the major mode name displays a major mode menu.
5925
5926 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
5927
5928 ** Hourglass pointer
5929
5930 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
5931 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
5932
5933 ** Blinking cursor
5934
5935 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
5936 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
5937 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
5938 the group `cursor'.
5939
5940 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
5941
5942 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
5943 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
5944 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
5945 details.
5946
5947 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
5948 have to do anything to activate it.
5949
5950 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
5951
5952 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
5953 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
5954
5955 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
5956 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
5957 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
5958 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
5959 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
5960 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
5961 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
5962 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
5963
5964 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
5965 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
5966 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
5967 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
5968 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
5969 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
5970
5971 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
5972 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
5973
5974 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
5975 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
5976 buffer by default.
5977
5978 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
5979 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
5980 beginning and end of the buffer.
5981
5982 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
5983 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
5984 signaled.
5985
5986 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
5987 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
5988
5989 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
5990 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
5991 this behavior.
5992
5993 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
5994 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
5995 Emacs dump core.
5996
5997 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
5998
5999 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
6000 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
6001 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
6002
6003 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
6004 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
6005 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
6006
6007 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
6008 using that menu.
6009
6010 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
6011
6012 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
6013 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
6014 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
6015 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
6016 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
6017 whitespace.
6018
6019 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
6020 all frames except the selected one.
6021
6022 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
6023 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
6024
6025 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
6026 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
6027 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
6028 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
6029 `Info-use-header-line'.
6030
6031 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
6032 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
6033 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
6034
6035 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
6036
6037 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
6038 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
6039 `fr-drdref.tex'.
6040
6041 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
6042 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
6043 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
6044 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
6045
6046 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
6047
6048 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
6049 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
6050 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
6051 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
6052
6053 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
6054 point in a pop-up window.
6055
6056 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
6057 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
6058 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
6059
6060 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
6061 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
6062
6063 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
6064 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
6065 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
6066 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
6067
6068 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
6069
6070 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
6071 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
6072
6073 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
6074 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
6075 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
6076
6077 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
6078 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
6079 non-nil.
6080
6081 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
6082 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
6083 file that is already visited under a different name.
6084
6085 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
6086 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
6087
6088 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
6089 and displays information about that.
6090
6091 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
6092 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
6093
6094 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
6095 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
6096 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
6097 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
6098 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
6099 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
6100
6101 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
6102 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
6103
6104 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
6105 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
6106 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
6107 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
6108 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
6109 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
6110 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
6111
6112 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
6113 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
6114
6115 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
6116 system for keyboard input.
6117
6118 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
6119 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
6120 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
6121 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
6122 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
6123 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
6124 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
6125 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
6126 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
6127
6128 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
6129 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
6130
6131 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
6132 displays all characters in that character set.
6133
6134 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
6135 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
6136
6137 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
6138 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
6139 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
6140
6141 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
6142 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
6143 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
6144 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
6145 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
6146 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
6147 and Polish `slash'.
6148
6149 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
6150 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
6151 of the tutorial.
6152
6153 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
6154 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
6155 Lisp Coding Convention".
6156
6157 new command old-binding
6158 --- ------- -----------
6159 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
6160 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
6161 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
6162
6163 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
6164 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
6165 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
6166
6167 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
6168 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
6169 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
6170 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
6171 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
6172 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
6173
6174 ** There are new Leim input methods.
6175 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
6176 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
6177 package.
6178
6179 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
6180 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
6181 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
6182 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
6183 "`", you must type "=q".
6184
6185 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
6186 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
6187 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
6188 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
6189 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
6190 on.
6191
6192 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
6193 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
6194 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
6195 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
6196
6197 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
6198 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
6199 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
6200 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
6201
6202 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
6203 on the display using several methods
6204
6205 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
6206 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
6207 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
6208
6209 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
6210 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
6211
6212 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
6213
6214 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
6215 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
6216
6217 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
6218 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
6219 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
6220 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
6221
6222 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
6223 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
6224 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
6225
6226 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
6227 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
6228
6229 ** New X resources recognized
6230
6231 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
6232 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
6233 is useful for debugging X problems.
6234
6235 Example:
6236
6237 emacs.synchronous: true
6238
6239 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
6240 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
6241 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
6242 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
6243 visual class names are
6244
6245 TrueColor
6246 PseudoColor
6247 DirectColor
6248 StaticColor
6249 GrayScale
6250 StaticGray
6251
6252 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
6253 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
6254 meaning.
6255
6256 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
6257 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
6258 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
6259 visual.
6260
6261 Example:
6262
6263 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
6264
6265 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
6266 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
6267 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
6268 resource values are `true' or `on'.
6269
6270 Example:
6271
6272 emacs.privateColormap: true
6273
6274 ** Faces and frame parameters.
6275
6276 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
6277 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
6278 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
6279 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
6280 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
6281 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
6282 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
6283
6284 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
6285 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
6286 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
6287 `default' face and vice versa.
6288
6289 ** New face `menu'.
6290
6291 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
6292
6293 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
6294
6295 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
6296 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
6297 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
6298 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
6299
6300 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
6301 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
6302 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
6303
6304 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
6305 `ScreenGamma'.
6306
6307 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
6308
6309 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
6310 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
6311 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
6312 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
6313
6314 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
6315
6316 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
6317
6318 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
6319
6320 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
6321 LessTif/Motif one.
6322
6323 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
6324 LessTif and Motif.
6325
6326 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
6327
6328 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
6329 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
6330 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
6331
6332 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
6333 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
6334
6335 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
6336 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
6337 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
6338
6339 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
6340
6341 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
6342 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
6343 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
6344 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
6345
6346 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
6347 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
6348 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
6349 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
6350
6351 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
6352 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
6353 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
6354 buffers.
6355
6356 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
6357
6358 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
6359 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
6360 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
6361
6362 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
6363 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
6364 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
6365 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
6366 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
6367 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
6368
6369 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
6370
6371 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
6372 notably at the end of lines.
6373
6374 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
6375 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
6376
6377 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
6378
6379 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
6380 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
6381
6382 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
6383 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
6384 after each match to get the replacement text.
6385
6386 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
6387 you edit the replacement string.
6388
6389 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
6390 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
6391 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
6392
6393 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
6394
6395 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
6396 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
6397
6398 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
6399 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
6400 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
6401 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
6402
6403 --
6404 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
6405 read mail from the menu etc.
6406
6407 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
6408 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
6409 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
6410 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
6411
6412 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
6413 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6414
6415 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
6416 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
6417 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
6418 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
6419 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
6420 of Emacs.
6421
6422 ** Customize changes
6423
6424 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
6425 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
6426 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
6427 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
6428 earlier versions of Emacs.
6429
6430 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
6431 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
6432 default).
6433
6434 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
6435 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
6436 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
6437 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
6438 file.
6439
6440 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
6441 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
6442 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
6443 already in your init file.
6444
6445 ** New features in evaluation commands
6446
6447 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
6448 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
6449 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
6450 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
6451 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
6452
6453 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
6454 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
6455 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
6456 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
6457 printed).
6458
6459 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
6460 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
6461
6462 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
6463 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
6464
6465 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
6466 code when called with a prefix argument.
6467
6468 ** CC mode changes.
6469
6470 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
6471 current user setups (although it's believed that these
6472 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
6473 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
6474 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
6475 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
6476 release.
6477
6478 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
6479 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
6480 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
6481 confusion.
6482
6483 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
6484 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
6485 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
6486 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
6487
6488 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
6489 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
6490
6491 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
6492 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
6493
6494 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
6495 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
6496 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
6497 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
6498
6499 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
6500 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
6501 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
6502 earlier statement. An example:
6503
6504 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
6505 if (a[i])
6506 res += a[i]->offset;
6507 else
6508
6509 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
6510 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
6511 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
6512 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
6513 the preceding "if".
6514
6515 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
6516 by default.
6517
6518 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
6519 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
6520 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
6521 documentation or other natural language text.
6522
6523 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
6524 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
6525 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
6526 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
6527 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
6528 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
6529 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
6530
6531 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
6532 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
6533 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
6534 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
6535
6536 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
6537 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
6538 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
6539 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
6540 Pike mode only.
6541
6542 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
6543 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
6544 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
6545 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
6546 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
6547 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
6548 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
6549 is reported afterwards.
6550
6551 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
6552 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
6553 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
6554
6555 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
6556 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
6557 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
6558 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
6559 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
6560 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
6561 groundwork.
6562
6563 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
6564 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
6565 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
6566 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
6567 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
6568 have to bother.
6569
6570 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
6571 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
6572 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
6573 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
6574 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
6575 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
6576
6577 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
6578 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
6579 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
6580 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
6581 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
6582 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
6583 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
6584 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
6585
6586 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
6587 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
6588 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
6589 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
6590 above.
6591
6592 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
6593 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
6594 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
6595 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
6596 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
6597 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
6598 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
6599 function documentation for more info.
6600
6601 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
6602 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
6603 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
6604 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
6605 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
6606 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
6607 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
6608 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
6609
6610 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
6611
6612 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
6613 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
6614
6615 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
6616 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
6617 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
6618 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
6619 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
6620 style system.
6621
6622 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
6623 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
6624 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
6625 as far as possible.
6626
6627 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
6628 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
6629 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
6630 chapter about this in the manual.
6631
6632 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
6633 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
6634 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
6635 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
6636 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
6637
6638 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
6639 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
6640 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
6641
6642 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
6643 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
6644
6645 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
6646 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
6647 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
6648 inside CC Mode.
6649
6650 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
6651 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
6652 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
6653 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
6654 cc-mode/).
6655
6656 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
6657 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
6658 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
6659 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
6660 they were before the filling.
6661
6662 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
6663 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
6664 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
6665 literals.
6666
6667 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
6668 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
6669 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
6670 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
6671 this function.
6672
6673 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
6674 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
6675 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
6676 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
6677 Thanks to Eric Eide.
6678
6679 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
6680 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
6681 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
6682
6683 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
6684
6685 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
6686 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
6687 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
6688 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
6689
6690 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
6691 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
6692 the column specified by comment-column.
6693
6694 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
6695 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
6696 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
6697 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
6698 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
6699 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
6700
6701 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
6702 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
6703 arguments.
6704
6705 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
6706
6707 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
6708 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
6709 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
6710 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
6711 Provan).
6712
6713 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
6714
6715 ** Dired changes
6716
6717 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
6718 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
6719 is, delete only empty directories.
6720
6721 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
6722 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
6723 copy directories recursively.
6724
6725 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
6726 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
6727 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
6728
6729 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
6730 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
6731 directory.
6732
6733 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
6734 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
6735 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
6736 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
6737 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
6738
6739 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
6740 from ls switches.
6741
6742 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
6743 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
6744 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
6745 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
6746
6747 ** Gnus changes.
6748
6749 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
6750 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
6751 internationalization and mail-fetching.
6752
6753 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
6754 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
6755
6756 If you used procmail like in
6757
6758 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
6759 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
6760 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
6761 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
6762
6763 this now has changed to
6764
6765 (setq mail-sources
6766 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
6767 :suffix ".in")))
6768
6769 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
6770 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
6771
6772 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
6773 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
6774 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
6775 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
6776
6777 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
6778 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
6779 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
6780
6781 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
6782 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
6783 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
6784 now just a compatibility layer.
6785
6786 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
6787 Gnus facilities.
6788
6789 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
6790 called to position point.
6791
6792 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
6793 summary buffers and NOV files.
6794
6795 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
6796 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
6797
6798 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
6799 subtly different manner.
6800
6801 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
6802 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
6803 ever-changing layouts.
6804
6805 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
6806
6807 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
6808
6809 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
6810
6811 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
6812 macros
6813
6814 Key binding Macro
6815 -------------------------
6816 C-c C-c C-s @strong
6817 C-c C-c C-e @emph
6818 C-c C-c u @uref
6819 C-c C-c q @quotation
6820 C-c C-c m @email
6821 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
6822 M-RET @item
6823
6824 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
6825
6826 ** Changes in Outline mode.
6827
6828 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
6829 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
6830 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
6831
6832 ** Changes to Emacs Server
6833
6834 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
6835 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
6836 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
6837 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
6838 buffers to kill, as before.
6839
6840 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
6841 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
6842 this way.
6843
6844 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
6845 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
6846
6847 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
6848
6849 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
6850 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
6851 use. Default is 1000.
6852
6853 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
6854 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
6855
6856 ** Changes to hideshow.el
6857
6858 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
6859
6860 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
6861 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
6862 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
6863 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
6864
6865 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
6866 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
6867 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
6868 the open block.
6869
6870 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
6871 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
6872 the normal block-hiding function.
6873
6874 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
6875
6876 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
6877 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
6878 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
6879 for `hs-minor-mode'.
6880
6881 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
6882 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
6883
6884 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
6885
6886 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
6887 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
6888 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
6889
6890 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
6891 current buffer.
6892
6893 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
6894 in a log file.
6895
6896 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
6897 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
6898 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
6899 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
6900 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
6901 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
6902
6903 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
6904
6905 ** Changes to cmuscheme
6906
6907 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
6908 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
6909
6910 ** Changes in Font Lock
6911
6912 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
6913 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
6914
6915 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
6916 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
6917
6918 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
6919 the face used for each string/comment.
6920
6921 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
6922 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
6923
6924 ** Changes to Shell mode
6925
6926 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
6927 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
6928 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
6929 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
6930
6931 ** Comint (subshell) changes
6932
6933 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
6934 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
6935
6936 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
6937 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
6938 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
6939 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
6940 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
6941 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
6942
6943 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
6944 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
6945 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
6946 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
6947 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
6948 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
6949 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
6950 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
6951
6952 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
6953 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
6954
6955 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
6956 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
6957 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
6958
6959 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
6960 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
6961 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
6962
6963 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
6964 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
6965 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
6966
6967 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
6968 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
6969 argument, it appends to the file.
6970
6971 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
6972 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
6973 compatibility.
6974
6975 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
6976 ring (history).
6977
6978 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
6979 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
6980 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
6981
6982 ** Changes to Rmail mode
6983
6984 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
6985 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
6986 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
6987 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
6988 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
6989 as correspondent.
6990
6991 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
6992 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
6993 regexp matching your mail addresses.
6994
6995 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
6996 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
6997 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
6998 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
6999 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
7000
7001 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
7002 like `j'.
7003
7004 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
7005 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
7006 digest message.
7007
7008 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
7009 in which folder to put messages automatically.
7010
7011 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
7012 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
7013 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
7014
7015 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
7016 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
7017
7018 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
7019 use the -f option when sending mail.
7020
7021 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
7022 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
7023 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
7024 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
7025 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
7026 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
7027
7028 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
7029 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
7030 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
7031
7032 ** Changes to TeX mode
7033
7034 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
7035 `latex-mode'.
7036
7037 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
7038
7039 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
7040
7041 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
7042
7043 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
7044
7045 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
7046 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
7047 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
7048 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
7049 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
7050 can be edited from that buffer.
7051
7052 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
7053 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
7054 `A' to use all marked entries).
7055
7056 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
7057 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
7058
7059 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
7060 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
7061 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
7062 been cited.
7063
7064 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
7065 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
7066 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
7067 in column 1 are always made leaves.
7068
7069 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
7070 has the following new features:
7071
7072 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
7073 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
7074 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
7075 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
7076
7077 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
7078 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
7079 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
7080 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
7081 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
7082 defaults to 1.
7083
7084 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
7085 file names.
7086
7087 ** Ispell changes
7088
7089 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
7090 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
7091 spell-checks the current buffer.
7092
7093 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
7094 added.
7095
7096 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
7097 correction is made and re-checked.
7098
7099 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
7100
7101 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
7102 cases.
7103
7104 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
7105 on syntax errors.
7106
7107 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
7108 end of the buffer.
7109
7110 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
7111
7112 ** Makefile mode changes
7113
7114 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
7115
7116 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
7117 Fontlock mode is active.
7118
7119 ** Isearch changes
7120
7121 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
7122 so that searches can be resumed.
7123
7124 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
7125 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
7126 that started the search.
7127
7128 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
7129 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
7130
7131 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
7132
7133 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
7134 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
7135 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
7136 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
7137 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
7138 `secondary-selection'.
7139
7140 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
7141 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
7142 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
7143 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
7144 usual snappy response.
7145
7146 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
7147 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
7148 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
7149 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
7150
7151 ** VC Changes
7152
7153 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
7154 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
7155 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
7156 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
7157 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
7158 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
7159 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
7160 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
7161 file is registered in that backend.
7162
7163 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
7164 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
7165 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
7166 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
7167 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
7168 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
7169
7170 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
7171 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
7172 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
7173 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
7174 where it doesn't make sense.)
7175
7176 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
7177 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
7178 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
7179
7180 *** General Changes
7181
7182 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
7183 checks are always done now.
7184
7185 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
7186 operations.
7187
7188 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
7189 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
7190 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
7191
7192 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
7193 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
7194 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
7195 the working file (``merge news'').
7196
7197 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
7198 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
7199 downwards.
7200
7201 *** Multiple Backends
7202
7203 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
7204 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
7205 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
7206 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
7207 local RCS archives.
7208
7209 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
7210 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
7211 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
7212 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
7213
7214 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
7215 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
7216 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
7217 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
7218 current revision number from the more remote backend.
7219
7220 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
7221 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
7222 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
7223 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
7224
7225 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
7226 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
7227 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
7228 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
7229
7230 *** Changes for CVS
7231
7232 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
7233 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
7234 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
7235 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
7236 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
7237 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
7238 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
7239
7240 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
7241 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
7242 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
7243 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
7244 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
7245 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
7246 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
7247 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
7248 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
7249 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
7250 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
7251 name.)
7252
7253 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
7254 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
7255 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
7256 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
7257 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
7258 entire directory tree.
7259
7260 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
7261 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
7262 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
7263 "watched" by other developers.)
7264
7265 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
7266 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
7267 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
7268 starting at the given directory.
7269
7270 *** Lisp Changes in VC
7271
7272 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
7273 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
7274 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
7275 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
7276 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
7277 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
7278 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
7279 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
7280 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
7281
7282 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
7283 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
7284 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
7285 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
7286
7287 ** New modes and packages
7288
7289 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
7290 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
7291 the default is not applicable.
7292
7293 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
7294 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
7295 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
7296
7297 Features are:
7298
7299 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
7300 drawn, like this: | \ /
7301 --+-- X
7302 | / \
7303
7304 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
7305 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
7306 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
7307 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
7308 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
7309 you are drawing.
7310
7311 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
7312 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
7313
7314 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
7315 flood-filling.
7316
7317 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
7318 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
7319 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
7320 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
7321
7322 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
7323 also do without the mouse.
7324
7325 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
7326 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
7327 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
7328 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
7329 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
7330
7331 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
7332
7333 lines straight-lines
7334 rectangles squares
7335 poly-lines straight poly-lines
7336 ellipses circles
7337 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
7338 spray-can setting size for spraying
7339 vaporize line vaporize lines
7340 erase characters erase rectangles
7341
7342 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
7343 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
7344 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
7345 drawing.
7346
7347 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
7348 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
7349 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
7350 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
7351
7352 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
7353 can be turned off).
7354
7355 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
7356 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
7357 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
7358 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
7359 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
7360 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
7361 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
7362 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
7363 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
7364
7365 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
7366 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
7367 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
7368 on certain projects.
7369
7370 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
7371 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
7372
7373 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
7374
7375 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
7376 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
7377 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
7378 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
7379 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
7380 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
7381 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
7382 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
7383
7384 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
7385 Emacs is idle.
7386
7387 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
7388 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
7389
7390 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
7391 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
7392
7393 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
7394 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
7395 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
7396 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
7397 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
7398
7399 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
7400 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
7401 separate Texinfo file.
7402
7403 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
7404 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
7405 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
7406 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
7407 enter check-in log messages.
7408
7409 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
7410 without invoking external programs.
7411
7412 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
7413 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
7414 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
7415 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
7416 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
7417
7418 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
7419 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
7420
7421 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
7422 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
7423
7424 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
7425 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
7426 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
7427 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
7428 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
7429 single step.
7430
7431 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
7432 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
7433 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
7434 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
7435
7436 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
7437 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
7438 actually modifying content of a buffer.
7439
7440 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
7441 PostScript.
7442
7443 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
7444
7445 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
7446
7447 ; comment (until end of line)
7448 A non-terminal
7449 "C" terminal
7450 ?C? special
7451 $A default non-terminal
7452 $"C" default terminal
7453 $?C? default special
7454 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
7455 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
7456 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
7457 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
7458 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
7459 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
7460 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
7461 C+ one or more occurrences of C
7462 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
7463 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
7464 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
7465 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
7466 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
7467 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
7468 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
7469
7470 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
7471
7472 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
7473 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
7474 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
7475 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
7476 equal signs of assignments.
7477
7478 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
7479 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
7480
7481 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
7482 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
7483 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
7484
7485 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
7486
7487 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
7488 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
7489 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
7490 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
7491 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
7492 which answers different needs.
7493
7494 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
7495 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
7496 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
7497 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
7498 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
7499 to be enabled.
7500
7501 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
7502 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
7503
7504 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
7505
7506 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
7507 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
7508 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
7509
7510 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
7511
7512 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
7513 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
7514 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
7515 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
7516 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
7517 and background colors.
7518
7519 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
7520 Pascal) language.
7521
7522 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
7523 the text at point.
7524
7525 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
7526
7527 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
7528
7529 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
7530 whitespace in a file.
7531
7532 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
7533 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
7534 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
7535 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
7536 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
7537 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
7538 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
7539
7540 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
7541
7542 Here is an example of columns:
7543
7544 horse apple bus
7545 dog pineapple car EXTRA
7546 porcupine strawberry airplane
7547
7548 Doing the following settings:
7549
7550 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
7551 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
7552 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
7553 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
7554
7555
7556 Selecting the lines above and typing:
7557
7558 M-x delimit-columns-region
7559
7560 It results:
7561
7562 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
7563 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
7564 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
7565
7566 delim-col has the following options:
7567
7568 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
7569 before all columns.
7570
7571 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
7572 between each column.
7573
7574 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
7575 after all columns.
7576
7577 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
7578 each column.
7579
7580 delim-col has the following commands:
7581
7582 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
7583 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
7584
7585 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
7586 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
7587 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
7588 recent file list can be displayed:
7589
7590 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
7591 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
7592 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
7593
7594 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
7595 dynamically change the menu appearance.
7596
7597 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
7598 text.
7599
7600 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
7601 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
7602 specific to Message mode.
7603
7604 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
7605 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
7606 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
7607
7608 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
7609 interface to access directory servers using different directory
7610 protocols. It has a separate manual.
7611
7612 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
7613 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
7614
7615 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
7616
7617 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
7618 minibuffer with completion.
7619
7620 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
7621 with the diary features.
7622
7623 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
7624 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
7625
7626 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
7627 Fill mode.
7628
7629 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
7630 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
7631 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
7632 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
7633
7634 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
7635 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
7636 `.g'.
7637
7638 ** Changes in sort.el
7639
7640 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
7641 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
7642 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
7643 numeric base.
7644
7645 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
7646
7647 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
7648 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
7649 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
7650
7651 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
7652 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
7653
7654 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
7655 output ^M at the end of lines.
7656
7657 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
7658 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
7659
7660 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
7661 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
7662 `(msb-mode 1)'.
7663
7664 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
7665 group.
7666
7667 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
7668 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
7669 are recognized:
7670
7671 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
7672 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
7673 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
7674 nil -- just delete one character.
7675
7676 Default value is `untabify'.
7677
7678 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
7679
7680 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
7681 symbol, not double-quoted.
7682
7683 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
7684 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
7685 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
7686 moved to lisp/obsolete.
7687
7688 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
7689 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
7690 `auto-compression-mode' command.
7691
7692 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
7693 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
7694 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
7695
7696 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
7697 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
7698
7699 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
7700 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
7701
7702 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
7703 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
7704
7705 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
7706 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
7707 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
7708 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
7709 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
7710 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
7711
7712 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
7713 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
7714
7715 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
7716
7717 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
7718 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
7719
7720 ** Shell script mode changes.
7721
7722 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
7723 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
7724 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
7725
7726 ** Etags changes.
7727
7728 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
7729
7730 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
7731 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
7732 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
7733 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
7734 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
7735
7736 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
7737 declarations when given the --declarations option.
7738
7739 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
7740 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
7741
7742 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
7743 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
7744 `template' keywords.
7745
7746 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
7747 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
7748
7749 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
7750 types.
7751
7752 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
7753
7754 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
7755
7756 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
7757 are now tagged.
7758
7759 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
7760
7761 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
7762 variables are tagged.
7763
7764 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
7765
7766 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
7767 for PSWrap.
7768
7769 ** Changes in etags.el
7770
7771 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
7772 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
7773 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
7774
7775 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
7776 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
7777
7778 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
7779 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
7780 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
7781 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
7782
7783 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
7784
7785 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
7786 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
7787
7788 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
7789
7790 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
7791 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
7792 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
7793
7794 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
7795 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
7796
7797 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
7798 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
7799
7800 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
7801 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
7802 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
7803 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
7804 point will go to the beginning of the file.
7805
7806 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
7807 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
7808 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
7809
7810 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
7811 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
7812 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
7813
7814 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
7815 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
7816 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
7817
7818 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
7819
7820 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
7821
7822 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
7823 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
7824 expression from that list, are not checked.
7825
7826 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
7827 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
7828 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
7829 the buffer, just like for the local files.
7830
7831 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
7832
7833 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
7834 displays local abbrevs, only.
7835
7836 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
7837 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
7838
7839 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
7840 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
7841 is measured in pixels.
7842
7843 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
7844 to be visited as images.
7845
7846 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
7847 were added to compile.el.
7848
7849 ** Withdrawn packages
7850
7851 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
7852 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
7853
7854 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
7855
7856 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
7857
7858 \f
7859 * Incompatible Lisp changes
7860
7861 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
7862 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
7863 See the sections below for details.
7864
7865 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
7866 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
7867 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
7868 to remove the properties of the copy.
7869
7870 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
7871 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
7872 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
7873 these properties are active.
7874
7875 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
7876 ranges may affect some code.
7877
7878 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
7879 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
7880 make a difference to some code.
7881
7882 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
7883 operates on the minibuffer.
7884
7885 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7886 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
7887 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
7888 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
7889 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
7890 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
7891 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
7892 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
7893 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
7894 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
7895 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
7896 the buffer as multibyte characters.
7897
7898 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
7899 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
7900 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
7901
7902 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
7903 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
7904 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
7905
7906 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
7907 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
7908 such as `mapconcat'.
7909
7910 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
7911 string.
7912
7913 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
7914 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
7915 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
7916 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
7917 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
7918 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
7919 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
7920 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
7921
7922 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
7923 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
7924 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
7925 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
7926 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
7927 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
7928 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
7929 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
7930 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
7931 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
7932
7933 \f
7934 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
7935 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
7936
7937 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
7938
7939 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
7940 allows the animated display of strings.
7941
7942 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
7943 interactive form of a function.
7944
7945 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
7946 between custom options. Example:
7947
7948 (defcustom default-input-method nil
7949 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
7950 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
7951 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
7952 :group 'mule
7953 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
7954 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
7955
7956 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
7957 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
7958 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
7959
7960 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
7961 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
7962 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
7963 (signal or normal termination).
7964
7965 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
7966 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
7967
7968 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
7969 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
7970
7971 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
7972 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
7973
7974 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
7975
7976 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
7977 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
7978 being deleted.
7979
7980 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
7981
7982 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
7983 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
7984 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
7985 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
7986 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
7987 charset.
7988
7989 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
7990 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
7991 message.
7992
7993 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
7994 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
7995
7996 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
7997 with the more general `:mask' property.
7998
7999 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
8000
8001 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
8002 backslash.
8003
8004 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
8005 is running in batch mode. For example,
8006
8007 (message "%s" (read t))
8008
8009 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
8010 to standard output.
8011
8012 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
8013 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
8014
8015 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
8016 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
8017 frame or window.
8018
8019 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
8020 were added
8021
8022 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
8023
8024 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
8025 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
8026
8027 - Function: remq ELT LIST
8028
8029 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
8030 comparison is done with `eq'.
8031
8032 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
8033
8034 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
8035 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
8036 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
8037
8038 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
8039 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
8040 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
8041
8042 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
8043 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
8044
8045 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
8046 function was declared obsolete.
8047
8048 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
8049 retained as an alias).
8050
8051 ** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
8052 the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
8053
8054 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
8055
8056 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
8057
8058 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
8059 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
8060 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
8061 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
8062 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
8063 means never include the minibuffer window.
8064
8065 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
8066
8067 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
8068
8069 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
8070
8071 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
8072 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
8073 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
8074 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
8075 returned.
8076
8077 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
8078 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
8079 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
8080 minibuffer even if it is active.
8081
8082 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
8083 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
8084 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
8085 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
8086 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
8087 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
8088
8089 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
8090 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
8091 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
8092 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
8093 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
8094 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
8095 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
8096
8097 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
8098 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
8099 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
8100
8101 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
8102 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
8103 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
8104 Default value is nil.
8105
8106 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
8107 meaning no limit.
8108
8109 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
8110 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
8111 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
8112
8113 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
8114 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
8115 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
8116
8117 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
8118 list of a primitive.
8119
8120 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
8121
8122 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
8123 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
8124 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
8125 than replacing the local map.
8126
8127 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
8128 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
8129 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
8130 instead.
8131
8132 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
8133
8134 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
8135 as promised long ago.
8136
8137 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
8138
8139 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
8140 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
8141 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
8142
8143 \f
8144 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
8145
8146 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
8147 regular expressions.
8148
8149 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
8150
8151 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
8152
8153 - Macro: rx SEXP
8154
8155 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
8156
8157 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
8158 notation.
8159
8160 STRING
8161 matches string STRING literally.
8162
8163 CHAR
8164 matches character CHAR literally.
8165
8166 `not-newline'
8167 matches any character except a newline.
8168 .
8169 `anything'
8170 matches any character
8171
8172 `(any SET)'
8173 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
8174 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
8175
8176 '(in SET)'
8177 like `any'.
8178
8179 `(not (any SET))'
8180 matches any character not in SET
8181
8182 `line-start'
8183 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
8184 in the text being matched
8185
8186 `line-end'
8187 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
8188
8189 `string-start'
8190 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
8191 string being matched against.
8192
8193 `string-end'
8194 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
8195 string being matched against.
8196
8197 `buffer-start'
8198 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
8199 buffer being matched against.
8200
8201 `buffer-end'
8202 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
8203 buffer being matched against.
8204
8205 `point'
8206 matches the empty string, but only at point.
8207
8208 `word-start'
8209 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
8210 word.
8211
8212 `word-end'
8213 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
8214
8215 `word-boundary'
8216 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
8217 word.
8218
8219 `(not word-boundary)'
8220 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
8221 word.
8222
8223 `digit'
8224 matches 0 through 9.
8225
8226 `control'
8227 matches ASCII control characters.
8228
8229 `hex-digit'
8230 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8231
8232 `blank'
8233 matches space and tab only.
8234
8235 `graphic'
8236 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8237 space, and DEL.
8238
8239 `printing'
8240 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8241 and DEL.
8242
8243 `alphanumeric'
8244 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8245 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8246
8247 `letter'
8248 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8249 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8250
8251 `ascii'
8252 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8253
8254 `nonascii'
8255 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8256
8257 `lower'
8258 matches anything lower-case.
8259
8260 `upper'
8261 matches anything upper-case.
8262
8263 `punctuation'
8264 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8265 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8266
8267 `space'
8268 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8269
8270 `word'
8271 matches anything that has word syntax.
8272
8273 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
8274 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
8275 of the following symbols.
8276
8277 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
8278 `punctuation' (\\s.)
8279 `word' (\\sw)
8280 `symbol' (\\s_)
8281 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
8282 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
8283 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
8284 `string-quote' (\\s\")
8285 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
8286 `escape' (\\s\\)
8287 `character-quote' (\\s/)
8288 `comment-start' (\\s<)
8289 `comment-end' (\\s>)
8290
8291 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
8292 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
8293
8294 `(category CATEGORY)'
8295 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
8296 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
8297
8298 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
8299 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
8300 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
8301 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
8302 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
8303 `symbol' (\\c5)
8304 `digit' (\\c6)
8305 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
8306 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
8307 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
8308 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
8309 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
8310 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
8311 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
8312 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
8313 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
8314 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
8315 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
8316 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
8317 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
8318 `ascii' (\\ca)
8319 `arabic' (\\cb)
8320 `chinese' (\\cc)
8321 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
8322 `greek' (\\cg)
8323 `korean' (\\ch)
8324 `indian' (\\ci)
8325 `japanese' (\\cj)
8326 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
8327 `latin' (\\cl)
8328 `lao' (\\co)
8329 `tibetan' (\\cq)
8330 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
8331 `thai' (\\ct)
8332 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
8333 `hebrew' (\\cw)
8334 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
8335 `can-break' (\\c|)
8336
8337 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
8338 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
8339
8340 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8341 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
8342
8343 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8344 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
8345 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
8346
8347 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8348 another name for `submatch'.
8349
8350 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8351 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
8352 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
8353 regular expression.
8354
8355 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
8356 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
8357 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
8358 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
8359 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
8360
8361 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
8362 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
8363
8364 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
8365 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8366
8367 `(0+ SEXP)'
8368 like `zero-or-more'.
8369
8370 `(* SEXP)'
8371 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8372
8373 `(*? SEXP)'
8374 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8375
8376 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
8377 matches one or more occurrences of A.
8378
8379 `(1+ SEXP)'
8380 like `one-or-more'.
8381
8382 `(+ SEXP)'
8383 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8384
8385 `(+? SEXP)'
8386 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8387
8388 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
8389 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
8390
8391 `(optional SEXP)'
8392 like `zero-or-one'.
8393
8394 `(? SEXP)'
8395 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8396
8397 `(?? SEXP)'
8398 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8399
8400 `(repeat N SEXP)'
8401 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8402
8403 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
8404 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8405
8406 `(eval FORM)'
8407 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
8408 `regexp-quote' it.
8409
8410 `(regexp REGEXP)'
8411 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
8412
8413 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
8414
8415 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
8416 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
8417 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
8418 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
8419
8420 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
8421 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
8422 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
8423 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
8424
8425 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
8426 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
8427 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
8428
8429 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
8430 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
8431 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
8432 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
8433 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
8434 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
8435 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
8436 eight-bit-graphic.
8437
8438 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
8439
8440 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
8441 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
8442 character set as previously.
8443
8444 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
8445 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
8446 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
8447
8448 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
8449 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
8450 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
8451 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
8452
8453 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
8454 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
8455
8456 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
8457 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
8458 "fontset-default".
8459
8460 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
8461 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
8462
8463 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
8464 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
8465 buffers and strings.
8466
8467 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
8468 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
8469 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
8470 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
8471 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
8472 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
8473 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
8474 also been deleted.
8475
8476 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
8477 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
8478 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
8479
8480 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
8481 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
8482 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
8483 may differ between buffer and string text.
8484
8485 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
8486 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
8487
8488 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
8489 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
8490 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
8491 `composition' from STRING.
8492
8493 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
8494 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
8495
8496 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
8497 obsolete.
8498
8499 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
8500 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
8501
8502 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
8503 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
8504 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
8505 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
8506
8507 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
8508 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
8509 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
8510 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
8511 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
8512 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
8513
8514 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
8515 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
8516 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
8517
8518 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
8519 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
8520 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
8521
8522 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
8523 have been introduced.
8524
8525 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
8526 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
8527 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
8528 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
8529 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
8530 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
8531 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
8532 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
8533 their multibyte equivalent.
8534
8535 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
8536 that offset in the file before writing.
8537
8538 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
8539 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
8540
8541 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
8542 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
8543 from which the command was issued.
8544
8545 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
8546 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
8547 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
8548 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
8549 operate on.
8550
8551 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
8552 to `window-buffer-height'.
8553
8554 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
8555
8556 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
8557 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
8558 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
8559
8560 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
8561 respectively.
8562
8563 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
8564 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
8565
8566 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
8567 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
8568 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
8569
8570 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
8571 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
8572 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
8573 is currently displayed in some window.
8574
8575 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
8576 argument function's results.
8577
8578 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
8579 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
8580 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
8581 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
8582 sequence).
8583
8584 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
8585 header in the list of headers passed to it.
8586
8587 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
8588 ignores differences in case and text representation.
8589
8590 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
8591 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
8592 as follows:
8593
8594 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
8595 nil don't display a cursor
8596 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
8597 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
8598 others display a box cursor.
8599
8600 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
8601 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
8602 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
8603 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
8604
8605 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
8606 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
8607 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
8608 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
8609
8610 Example:
8611
8612 (string-to-syntax "()")
8613 => (4 . 41)
8614
8615 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
8616 other than 10.
8617
8618 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
8619 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
8620
8621 #b1111
8622 => 15
8623 #b-1111
8624 => -15
8625
8626 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
8627
8628 #o666
8629 => 438
8630
8631 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
8632
8633 #xbeef
8634 => 48815
8635
8636 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
8637
8638 #2R-111
8639 => -7
8640 #25rah
8641 => 267
8642
8643 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
8644 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
8645 and isn't a string.
8646
8647 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
8648 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
8649 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
8650 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
8651
8652 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
8653
8654 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
8655 for a regexp in a string.
8656
8657 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
8658 `mouse-position-function'.
8659
8660 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
8661 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
8662
8663 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
8664 Keywords are now always considered constants.
8665
8666 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
8667 returns it.
8668
8669 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
8670 returned by function `recent-keys'.
8671
8672 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
8673 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
8674 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
8675 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
8676 mode.
8677
8678 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
8679 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
8680
8681 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
8682 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
8683 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
8684 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
8685 been performed."
8686
8687 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
8688 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
8689 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
8690 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
8691
8692 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
8693 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
8694 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
8695
8696 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
8697 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
8698 specified table.
8699
8700 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
8701
8702 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
8703 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
8704 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
8705 what BODY returns.
8706
8707 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
8708 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
8709 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
8710 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
8711 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
8712
8713 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
8714 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
8715
8716 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
8717 instead of being optional.
8718
8719 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
8720 modify read-only text.
8721
8722 ** New functions and variables for locales.
8723
8724 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
8725 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
8726 time functions like strftime. The new variables
8727 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
8728 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
8729
8730 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
8731 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
8732 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
8733 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
8734 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
8735 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
8736 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
8737
8738 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
8739 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
8740 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
8741 start sequences.
8742
8743 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
8744 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
8745
8746 ** New function `propertize'
8747
8748 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
8749 strings with text properties.
8750
8751 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
8752
8753 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
8754 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
8755 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
8756 specified value of that property. Example:
8757
8758 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
8759
8760 ** push and pop macros.
8761
8762 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
8763 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
8764 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
8765
8766 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
8767 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
8768 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
8769
8770 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
8771
8772 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
8773 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
8774
8775 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
8776 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
8777 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
8778 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8779
8780 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
8781 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
8782 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
8783 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8784
8785 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
8786 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
8787 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
8788 or a sign.
8789
8790 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
8791 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
8792 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8793 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
8794 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8795 space, and DEL.
8796 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8797 and DEL.
8798 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
8799 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8800 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8801 [:alpha:] matches letters.
8802 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8803 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8804 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8805 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8806 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
8807 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
8808 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8809 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8810 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8811 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
8812 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
8813
8814 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
8815
8816 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
8817
8818 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
8819
8820 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
8821 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
8822
8823 :test TEST
8824
8825 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
8826 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
8827 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
8828
8829 :size SIZE
8830
8831 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
8832 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
8833
8834 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
8835
8836 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
8837 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
8838 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
8839 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
8840 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
8841
8842 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
8843
8844 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
8845 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
8846 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
8847
8848 :weakness WEAK
8849
8850 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
8851 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
8852 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
8853 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
8854 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
8855
8856 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
8857
8858 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
8859
8860 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
8861
8862 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
8863
8864 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
8865
8866 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
8867 values are shared.
8868
8869 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
8870
8871 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
8872
8873 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8874
8875 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
8876
8877 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
8878
8879 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
8880
8881 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8882
8883 Returns the size of TABLE.
8884
8885 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
8886
8887 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
8888
8889 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
8890
8891 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
8892
8893 - Function: clrhash TABLE
8894
8895 Clear TABLE.
8896
8897 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
8898
8899 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
8900 not found.
8901
8902 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
8903
8904 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
8905 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
8906
8907 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
8908
8909 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
8910
8911 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
8912
8913 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
8914 arguments KEY and VALUE.
8915
8916 - Function: sxhash OBJ
8917
8918 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
8919
8920 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
8921
8922 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
8923 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
8924 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
8925 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
8926 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
8927
8928 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
8929
8930 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
8931 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
8932 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
8933
8934 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
8935 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
8936
8937 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
8938 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
8939
8940 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
8941 (sxhash (upcase a)))
8942
8943 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
8944 'case-fold-string-hash))
8945
8946 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
8947
8948 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
8949
8950 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
8951 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
8952 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
8953
8954 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
8955
8956 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
8957 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
8958
8959 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
8960 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
8961 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
8962 is too short to reach that column.
8963
8964 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
8965 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
8966 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
8967 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
8968
8969 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
8970 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
8971 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
8972
8973 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
8974 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
8975
8976 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
8977 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
8978
8979 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
8980 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
8981 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
8982 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
8983 temporary-file-directory instead.
8984
8985 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
8986 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
8987 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
8988 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
8989
8990 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
8991 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
8992
8993 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
8994
8995 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
8996 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
8997 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
8998
8999 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
9000
9001 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
9002 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
9003 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
9004 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
9005 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
9006 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
9007
9008 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
9009 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
9010 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
9011 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
9012
9013 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
9014
9015 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
9016 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
9017 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
9018 result string.
9019
9020 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
9021 string where arguments appear in the result string.
9022
9023 Example:
9024
9025 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
9026 (s2 "world"))
9027 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
9028 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
9029 (format s1 s2))
9030
9031 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
9032
9033 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
9034
9035 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
9036 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
9037 argument in it.
9038
9039 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
9040 (arg "world"))
9041 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
9042 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
9043 (message msg arg))
9044
9045 ** Sound support
9046
9047 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
9048 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
9049
9050 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
9051 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
9052 to enable sound support.
9053
9054 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
9055 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
9056 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
9057 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
9058 sound to play, before playing the sound.
9059
9060 The following sound properties are supported:
9061
9062 - `:file FILE'
9063
9064 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
9065 searched relative to `data-directory'.
9066
9067 - `:data DATA'
9068
9069 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
9070 may be present, but not both.
9071
9072 - `:volume VOLUME'
9073
9074 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
9075 0..1. This property is optional.
9076
9077 - `:device DEVICE'
9078
9079 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
9080 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
9081
9082 Other properties are ignored.
9083
9084 An alternative interface is called as
9085 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
9086
9087 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
9088
9089 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
9090 a keyword symbol.
9091
9092 ** Changes to garbage collection
9093
9094 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
9095 of live and free strings.
9096
9097 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
9098 strings that have been consed so far.
9099
9100 \f
9101 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
9102 Lisp Manual
9103
9104 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
9105 mini-windows.
9106
9107 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
9108 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
9109 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
9110
9111 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
9112
9113 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
9114
9115 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
9116 image.
9117
9118 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
9119
9120 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
9121
9122 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
9123 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
9124 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
9125 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
9126 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
9127
9128 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
9129 has a mask bitmap.
9130
9131 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
9132
9133 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
9134 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
9135 or omitted means use the selected frame.
9136
9137 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
9138 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
9139
9140 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
9141 optional.
9142
9143 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
9144 below).
9145
9146 \f
9147 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
9148
9149 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
9150 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
9151
9152 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
9153 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
9154 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
9155 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
9156 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
9157 just display it black instead.
9158
9159 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
9160 a line like
9161
9162 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
9163
9164 in your `.emacs'.
9165
9166 ** New face implementation.
9167
9168 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
9169 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
9170
9171 *** New faces.
9172
9173 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
9174
9175 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
9176
9177 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
9178 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
9179
9180 3. Font height in 1/10pt
9181
9182 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
9183
9184 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
9185
9186 6. Foreground color.
9187
9188 7. Background color.
9189
9190 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
9191
9192 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
9193
9194 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
9195
9196 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
9197
9198 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
9199 color.
9200
9201 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
9202 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
9203
9204 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
9205 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
9206 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
9207 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
9208 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
9209 attributes mentioned above.
9210
9211 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
9212 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
9213 created frames.
9214
9215 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
9216 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
9217 `fully-specified'.
9218
9219 *** Face merging.
9220
9221 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
9222 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
9223 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
9224 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
9225 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
9226 results in a fully-specified face.
9227
9228 *** Face realization.
9229
9230 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
9231 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
9232 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
9233 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
9234 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
9235 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
9236
9237 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
9238 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
9239 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
9240 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
9241
9242 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
9243 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
9244 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
9245 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
9246 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
9247
9248 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
9249 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
9250 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
9251 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
9252 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
9253 Emacs.
9254
9255 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
9256 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
9257 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
9258 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
9259
9260 **** Clearing face caches.
9261
9262 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
9263 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
9264 unused fonts.
9265
9266 *** Font selection.
9267
9268 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
9269 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
9270 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
9271
9272 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
9273 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
9274 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
9275 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
9276 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
9277
9278 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
9279 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
9280 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
9281
9282 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
9283
9284 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
9285 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
9286 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
9287 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
9288 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
9289 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
9290 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
9291
9292 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
9293 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
9294 doesn't exist.
9295
9296 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
9297 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
9298 registry.
9299
9300 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
9301 slightly different.
9302
9303 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
9304
9305
9306 **** Scalable fonts
9307
9308 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
9309 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
9310 servers.
9311
9312 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
9313 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
9314 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
9315 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
9316 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
9317 that list. Example:
9318
9319 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
9320
9321 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
9322
9323 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
9324
9325 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
9326
9327 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
9328 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
9329 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
9330
9331 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
9332 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
9333 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
9334 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
9335 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
9336 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
9337 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
9338 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
9339 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
9340 of the face font sort order.
9341
9342 - Function: x-font-family-list
9343
9344 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
9345 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
9346 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
9347 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
9348
9349 - Variable: font-list-limit
9350
9351 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
9352 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
9353 matching font. The default is currently 100.
9354
9355 *** Setting face attributes.
9356
9357 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
9358 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
9359 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
9360 `face-attribute'.
9361
9362 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
9363 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
9364
9365 The following attributes are recognized:
9366
9367 `:family'
9368
9369 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
9370 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
9371 and `?' are allowed.
9372
9373 `:width'
9374
9375 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
9376 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
9377 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
9378 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
9379
9380 `:height'
9381
9382 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
9383 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
9384 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
9385 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
9386
9387 `:weight'
9388
9389 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
9390 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
9391 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
9392
9393 `:slant'
9394
9395 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
9396 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
9397 `reverse-oblique'.
9398
9399 `:foreground', `:background'
9400
9401 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
9402
9403 `:underline'
9404
9405 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
9406 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
9407 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
9408 don't underline.
9409
9410 `:overline'
9411
9412 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
9413 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
9414 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
9415 overline.
9416
9417 `:strike-through'
9418
9419 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
9420 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
9421 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
9422 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
9423
9424 `:box'
9425
9426 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
9427 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
9428 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
9429 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
9430 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
9431 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
9432 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
9433 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
9434 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
9435 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
9436 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
9437 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
9438 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
9439 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
9440 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
9441 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
9442 box.
9443
9444 `:inverse-video'
9445
9446 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
9447 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
9448
9449 `:stipple'
9450
9451 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
9452 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
9453 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
9454 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
9455 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
9456 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
9457
9458 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
9459 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
9460
9461 `:font'
9462
9463 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
9464 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
9465 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
9466 versions of Emacs.
9467
9468 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
9469 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
9470 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
9471
9472 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
9473 `defface'.
9474
9475 `:inherit'
9476
9477 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
9478 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
9479 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
9480
9481 *** Face attributes and X resources
9482
9483 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
9484 from X resources:
9485
9486 Face attribute X resource class
9487 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
9488 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
9489 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
9490 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
9491 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
9492 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
9493 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
9494 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
9495 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
9496 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
9497 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
9498 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
9499 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
9500 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
9501 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
9502 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
9503 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
9504 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
9505 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
9506 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
9507
9508 *** Text property `face'.
9509
9510 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
9511 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
9512 specification can be
9513
9514 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
9515
9516 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
9517 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
9518 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
9519 for face attribute names.
9520
9521 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
9522 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
9523 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
9524
9525 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
9526
9527 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
9528 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
9529 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
9530 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
9531 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
9532 used to clear the mapping table.
9533
9534 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
9535
9536 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
9537 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
9538 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
9539 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
9540 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
9541 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
9542 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
9543 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
9544 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
9545 modify their color-related behavior.
9546
9547 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
9548 any frame type.
9549
9550 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
9551
9552 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
9553 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
9554 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
9555 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
9556 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
9557 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
9558 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
9559 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
9560 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
9561
9562 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
9563 display can display image files.
9564
9565 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
9566
9567 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
9568 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
9569 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
9570 `Inviolable' option.
9571
9572 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
9573 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
9574 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
9575
9576 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
9577
9578 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
9579 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
9580 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
9581
9582 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
9583 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
9584 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
9585 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
9586 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
9587 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
9588 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
9589 functions.
9590
9591 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
9592 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
9593 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
9594
9595 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
9596
9597 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
9598
9599 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
9600
9601 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9602 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
9603 constrained position if that is different.
9604
9605 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
9606 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
9607 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
9608 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
9609 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9610 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
9611 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
9612 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
9613 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
9614
9615 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
9616 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
9617 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
9618 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
9619 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
9620
9621 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
9622 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
9623
9624 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
9625
9626 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
9627
9628 Delete the field surrounding POS.
9629 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9630 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9631
9632 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9633
9634 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
9635 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9636 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9637 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
9638 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
9639
9640 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9641
9642 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
9643 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9644 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9645 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
9646 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
9647
9648 - Function: field-string &optional POS
9649
9650 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
9651 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9652 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9653
9654 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
9655
9656 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
9657 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9658 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9659
9660 ** Image support.
9661
9662 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
9663 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
9664 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
9665 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
9666
9667 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
9668 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
9669 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
9670 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
9671 area.
9672
9673 IMAGE is an image specification.
9674
9675 *** Image specifications
9676
9677 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
9678 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
9679 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
9680 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
9681 described below are ignored.
9682
9683 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
9684
9685 `:ascent ASCENT'
9686
9687 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
9688 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
9689 to use for its ascent.
9690
9691 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
9692 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
9693
9694 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
9695 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
9696 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
9697 overlays that apply to the image.
9698
9699 `:margin MARGIN'
9700
9701 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
9702 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
9703 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
9704
9705 `:relief RELIEF'
9706
9707 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
9708 around an image.
9709
9710 `:conversion ALGO'
9711
9712 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
9713
9714 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
9715 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
9716
9717 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
9718 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
9719 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
9720 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
9721 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
9722 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
9723 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
9724 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
9725 below.
9726
9727 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
9728 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
9729 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
9730
9731 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
9732 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
9733 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
9734 of the factors' absolute values.
9735
9736 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
9737
9738 (1 0 0
9739 0 0 0
9740 9 9 -1)
9741
9742 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
9743
9744 ( 2 -1 0
9745 -1 0 1
9746 0 1 -2)
9747
9748 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
9749 ``disabled''.
9750
9751 `:mask MASK'
9752
9753 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
9754 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
9755 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
9756 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
9757 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
9758 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
9759 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
9760 image.
9761
9762 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
9763 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
9764 `:mask nil'.
9765
9766 `:file FILE'
9767
9768 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
9769 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
9770 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
9771 may be present in the image specification.
9772
9773 `:data DATA'
9774
9775 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
9776 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
9777 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
9778 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
9779
9780 *** Supported image types
9781
9782 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
9783
9784 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
9785 properties supported are:
9786
9787 `:foreground FG'
9788
9789 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9790 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9791
9792 `:background BG'
9793
9794 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9795 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9796
9797 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
9798 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
9799 instead of a `:file' property.
9800
9801 `:width WIDTH'
9802
9803 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
9804
9805 `:height HEIGHT'
9806
9807 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
9808
9809 `:data DATA'
9810
9811 DATA must be either
9812
9813 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
9814 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
9815
9816 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
9817
9818 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
9819 bitmap.
9820
9821 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
9822 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
9823 in the file.
9824
9825 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
9826
9827 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
9828 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
9829 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
9830 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
9831
9832 Additional image properties supported are:
9833
9834 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
9835
9836 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
9837 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
9838 name.
9839
9840 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
9841 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
9842
9843 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
9844 to display compressed images.
9845
9846 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
9847
9848 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
9849 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
9850 mono images are:
9851
9852 `:foreground FG'
9853
9854 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9855 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9856
9857 `:background FG'
9858
9859 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9860 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9861
9862 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
9863
9864 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
9865 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9866 properties defined.
9867
9868 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
9869
9870 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
9871 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9872 properties defined.
9873
9874 **** GIF, image type `gif'
9875
9876 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
9877 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
9878
9879 Additional image properties supported are:
9880
9881 `:index INDEX'
9882
9883 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
9884 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
9885 as a hollow box.
9886
9887 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
9888 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
9889 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
9890 every 0.1 seconds.
9891
9892 (defun show-anim (file max)
9893 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
9894 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
9895
9896 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
9897 (when (= idx max)
9898 (setq idx 0))
9899 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
9900 (save-excursion
9901 (set-buffer buffer)
9902 (goto-char (point-min))
9903 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
9904 (insert-image img "x"))
9905 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
9906
9907 **** PNG, image type `png'
9908
9909 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
9910 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9911 properties defined.
9912
9913 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
9914
9915 Additional image properties supported are:
9916
9917 `:pt-width WIDTH'
9918
9919 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
9920 integer. This is a required property.
9921
9922 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
9923
9924 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
9925 must be a integer. This is an required property.
9926
9927 `:bounding-box BOX'
9928
9929 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
9930 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
9931 files. This is an required property.
9932
9933 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
9934 lisp/gs.el.
9935
9936 *** Lisp interface.
9937
9938 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
9939 which are supported in the current configuration.
9940
9941 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
9942 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
9943 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
9944 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
9945 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
9946
9947 *** Simplified image API, image.el
9948
9949 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
9950 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
9951 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
9952 define an image based on available image types. The functions
9953 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
9954 buffer.
9955
9956 ** Display margins.
9957
9958 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
9959 and images.
9960
9961 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
9962 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
9963 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
9964 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
9965 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
9966 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
9967 of the display margins.
9968
9969 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
9970 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
9971 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
9972 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
9973 in this file).
9974
9975 ** Help display
9976
9977 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
9978 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
9979 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
9980 that have a `help-echo' property.
9981
9982 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
9983 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
9984 the window in which the help was found.
9985
9986 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
9987 `help-echo' text property was found.
9988
9989 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
9990 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
9991
9992 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
9993 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
9994 mouse.
9995
9996 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
9997 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
9998
9999 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
10000 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
10001 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
10002 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
10003 used as help string.
10004
10005 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
10006 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
10007 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
10008
10009 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
10010
10011 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
10012 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
10013
10014 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
10015 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
10016 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
10017 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
10018 used.
10019
10020 (global-set-key [A-down]
10021 #'(lambda ()
10022 (interactive)
10023 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
10024 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
10025 (global-set-key [A-up]
10026 #'(lambda ()
10027 (interactive)
10028 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
10029 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
10030
10031 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
10032
10033 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
10034 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
10035 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
10036 is called with one argument, POS.
10037
10038 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
10039 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
10040 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
10041 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
10042 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
10043
10044 ** Tool bar support.
10045
10046 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
10047 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
10048 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
10049 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
10050 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
10051 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
10052
10053 *** Tool bar item definitions
10054
10055 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
10056 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
10057 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
10058
10059 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
10060 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
10061 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
10062 property (see below).
10063
10064 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
10065 binding are currently ignored.
10066
10067 The following properties are recognized:
10068
10069 `:enable FORM'.
10070
10071 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
10072 or disabled.
10073
10074 `:visible FORM'
10075
10076 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
10077
10078 `:filter FUNCTION'
10079
10080 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
10081 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
10082 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
10083
10084 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
10085
10086 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
10087 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
10088
10089 `:image IMAGES'
10090
10091 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
10092 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
10093 meaning of each of the four elements:
10094
10095 Index Use when item is
10096 ----------------------------------------
10097 0 enabled and selected
10098 1 enabled and deselected
10099 2 disabled and selected
10100 3 disabled and deselected
10101
10102 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
10103 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
10104
10105 `:help HELP-STRING'.
10106
10107 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
10108 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
10109
10110 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
10111 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
10112 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
10113 menu bar.
10114
10115 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
10116 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
10117 buffer-locally to override the global map.
10118
10119 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
10120
10121 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
10122 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
10123 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
10124
10125 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
10126 raised when the mouse moves over them.
10127
10128 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
10129 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
10130 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
10131 vertical margins . Default is 1.
10132
10133 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
10134 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
10135
10136 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
10137
10138 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
10139 a tool bar item. If
10140
10141 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
10142 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
10143 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
10144
10145 is the original tool bar item definition, then
10146
10147 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
10148
10149 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
10150 item.
10151
10152 ** Mode line changes.
10153
10154 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
10155
10156 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
10157 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
10158 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
10159
10160 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
10161 a `local-map' text property.
10162
10163 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
10164 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
10165
10166 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
10167 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
10168 `local-map' property.
10169
10170 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
10171 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
10172 example.
10173
10174 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
10175 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
10176
10177 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
10178 variable mode-line-format to nil.
10179
10180 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
10181
10182 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
10183 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
10184 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
10185 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
10186 line.
10187
10188 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
10189 `header-line'.
10190
10191 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
10192 position in the header-line.
10193
10194 ** Text property `display'
10195
10196 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
10197 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
10198 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
10199 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
10200 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
10201
10202 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
10203
10204 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
10205 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
10206
10207 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
10208 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
10209 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
10210 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
10211 simpler form STRING as property value.
10212
10213 *** Variable width and height spaces
10214
10215 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
10216 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
10217 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
10218 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
10219 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
10220 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
10221 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
10222
10223 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
10224 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
10225 properties described below.
10226
10227 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
10228 characters having the `display' property.
10229
10230 - :width WIDTH
10231
10232 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
10233 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
10234
10235 - :relative-width FACTOR
10236
10237 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
10238 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
10239 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
10240 width of that character by FACTOR.
10241
10242 - :align-to HPOS
10243
10244 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
10245 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
10246
10247 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
10248
10249 - :height HEIGHT
10250
10251 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
10252 normal line height.
10253
10254 - :relative-height FACTOR
10255
10256 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
10257 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
10258
10259 - :ascent ASCENT
10260
10261 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
10262 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
10263 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
10264 equal to 100.
10265
10266 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
10267
10268 *** Images
10269
10270 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
10271 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
10272 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
10273 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
10274 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
10275 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
10276 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
10277 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
10278 as display specification.
10279
10280 *** Other display properties
10281
10282 - (space-width FACTOR)
10283
10284 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
10285 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
10286 integer or float.
10287
10288 - (height HEIGHT)
10289
10290 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
10291
10292 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
10293 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
10294 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
10295 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
10296 a font is available counts as a step.
10297
10298 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
10299 as tall as the frame's default font.
10300
10301 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
10302 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
10303
10304 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
10305 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
10306
10307 - (raise FACTOR)
10308
10309 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
10310 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
10311 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
10312 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
10313 `height' subproperty.
10314
10315 *** Conditional display properties
10316
10317 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
10318 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
10319 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
10320 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
10321 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
10322 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
10323 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
10324 different when object is a string.
10325
10326 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
10327 `(when t . SPEC)'.
10328
10329 ** New menu separator types.
10330
10331 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
10332 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
10333 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
10334 to specify other menu separator types.
10335
10336 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
10337
10338 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
10339 separator occurs.
10340
10341 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
10342
10343 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
10344
10345 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
10346
10347 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
10348
10349 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
10350
10351 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
10352
10353 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
10354
10355 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
10356
10357 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
10358
10359 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
10360 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
10361
10362 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
10363
10364 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
10365
10366 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
10367
10368 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
10369
10370 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
10371
10372 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
10373
10374 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
10375
10376 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
10377
10378 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
10379
10380 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
10381
10382 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
10383
10384 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
10385
10386 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
10387
10388 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
10389
10390 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
10391 the corresponding single-line separators.
10392
10393 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
10394
10395 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
10396 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
10397 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
10398 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
10399 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
10400 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
10401 default foreground is black.
10402
10403 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
10404 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
10405 `ScrollBarBackground').
10406
10407 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
10408 settings for scroll bar colors.
10409
10410 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
10411 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
10412
10413 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
10414 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
10415 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
10416 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
10417 the original window start.
10418
10419 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
10420 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
10421 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
10422
10423 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
10424
10425 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
10426 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
10427 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
10428 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
10429
10430 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
10431 fixed-width and fixed-height.
10432
10433 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
10434
10435 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
10436 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
10437 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
10438 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
10439 temporarily to nil, for example
10440
10441 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
10442 (enlarge-window 10))
10443
10444 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
10445 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
10446
10447 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
10448 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
10449 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
10450 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
10451 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
10452 support a vertical-bar cursor).
10453
10454
10455 \f
10456 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
10457
10458 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
10459 input.
10460
10461 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
10462
10463 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
10464
10465 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
10466 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
10467 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
10468 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
10469 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
10470
10471 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
10472 been added.
10473
10474 \f
10475 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
10476
10477 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
10478
10479
10480 \f
10481 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
10482
10483 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
10484 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
10485 \f
10486 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
10487
10488 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
10489
10490 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
10491 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
10492 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
10493
10494 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
10495 is the one that is used.
10496
10497 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
10498 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
10499 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
10500 separate from the command's regular output.
10501 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
10502 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
10503 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
10504 the buffer name.
10505
10506 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
10507 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
10508 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
10509 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
10510
10511 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
10512 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
10513 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
10514 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
10515
10516 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
10517 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
10518 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
10519 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
10520
10521 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
10522 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
10523 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
10524 they never ignore case.
10525
10526 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
10527 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
10528 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
10529 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
10530 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
10531 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
10532 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
10533
10534 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
10535 the same format that was used in the file before.
10536
10537 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
10538 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
10539
10540 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
10541 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
10542 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
10543
10544 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
10545 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
10546 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
10547 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
10548 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
10549 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
10550 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
10551
10552 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
10553 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
10554 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
10555 format. You can now customize these variables.
10556
10557 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
10558 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
10559 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
10560 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
10561
10562 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
10563 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
10564 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
10565
10566 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
10567 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
10568 doesn't have any effect.
10569
10570 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
10571 not one per buffer.
10572
10573 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
10574 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
10575 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
10576
10577 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
10578 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
10579 `auto-show-mode' command.
10580
10581 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
10582 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
10583 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
10584 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
10585 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
10586
10587 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
10588 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
10589
10590 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
10591 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
10592 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
10593
10594 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
10595 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
10596 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
10597 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
10598
10599 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
10600
10601 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
10602 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
10603 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
10604 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
10605 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
10606
10607 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
10608 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
10609
10610 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
10611 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
10612 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
10613 `?' on other systems.
10614
10615 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
10616 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
10617 Unix.
10618
10619 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
10620 current codepage when it starts.
10621
10622 ** Mail changes
10623
10624 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
10625 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
10626 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
10627 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
10628 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
10629 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
10630 latin-1:
10631
10632 MIME-version: 1.0
10633 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
10634 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
10635
10636 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
10637 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
10638 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
10639 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
10640 buffer-file-coding-system.
10641
10642 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
10643 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
10644 mail.
10645
10646 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
10647 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
10648 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
10649 list of possible coding systems.
10650
10651 ** CC Mode changes
10652
10653 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
10654 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
10655 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
10656 docstring for details.
10657
10658 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
10659 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
10660 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
10661 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
10662 lineup functions use this feature currently.
10663
10664 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
10665 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
10666
10667 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
10668 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
10669
10670 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
10671 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
10672 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
10673 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
10674 anonymous classes.
10675
10676 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
10677 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
10678
10679 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
10680 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
10681 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
10682 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
10683
10684 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
10685 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
10686 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
10687 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
10688 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
10689
10690 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
10691
10692 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
10693
10694 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
10695 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
10696
10697 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
10698
10699 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
10700 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
10701 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
10702 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
10703 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
10704
10705 ** Gnus changes.
10706
10707 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
10708 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
10709 Gnus manual for the full story.
10710
10711 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
10712 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
10713 group, which is created automatically.
10714
10715 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
10716 values.
10717
10718 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
10719
10720 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
10721 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
10722
10723 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
10724 `C-u C-c C-c'.
10725
10726 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
10727
10728 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
10729 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
10730
10731 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
10732
10733 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
10734 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
10735
10736 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
10737 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
10738
10739 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
10740 control over simplification.
10741
10742 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
10743
10744 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
10745 limit.
10746
10747 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
10748
10749 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
10750
10751 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
10752 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
10753 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
10754
10755 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
10756 `a' forces normal posting method.
10757
10758 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
10759 -- `W d'.
10760
10761 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
10762 to a non-nil value.
10763
10764 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
10765 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
10766
10767 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
10768 has been added.
10769
10770 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
10771
10772 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
10773
10774 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
10775 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
10776
10777 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
10778 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
10779
10780 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
10781
10782 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
10783 been added.
10784
10785 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
10786 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
10787
10788 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
10789 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
10790
10791 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
10792
10793 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
10794
10795 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
10796
10797 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
10798
10799 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
10800 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
10801 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
10802
10803 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
10804 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
10805 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
10806 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
10807 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
10808
10809 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
10810 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
10811 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
10812 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
10813
10814 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
10815 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
10816 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
10817 mismatch.
10818
10819 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10820
10821 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
10822 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
10823
10824 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
10825 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
10826 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
10827 removed from the label.
10828
10829 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
10830 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
10831
10832 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
10833 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
10834
10835 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
10836 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
10837 expressions.
10838
10839 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
10840
10841 ** New/deleted modes and packages
10842
10843 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
10844 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
10845
10846 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
10847 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
10848 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
10849
10850 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
10851 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
10852 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
10853 \f
10854 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
10855
10856 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
10857 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
10858 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
10859 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
10860 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
10861
10862 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
10863 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
10864 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
10865
10866 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
10867 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
10868 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
10869 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
10870 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
10871 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
10872 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
10873 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
10874 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
10875
10876 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
10877 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
10878 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
10879 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
10880 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
10881 program.
10882
10883 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
10884 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
10885 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
10886 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
10887 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
10888 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
10889
10890 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
10891 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
10892 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
10893 was not documented clearly before.
10894
10895 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
10896 This includes Tetris and Snake.
10897 \f
10898 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
10899
10900 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
10901 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
10902 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
10903 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
10904
10905 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
10906 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
10907 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
10908
10909 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
10910
10911 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
10912 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
10913
10914 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
10915 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
10916 integers.
10917
10918 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
10919 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
10920 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
10921 file names and attributes are returned.
10922
10923 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
10924 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
10925 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
10926 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
10927 returns the result.
10928
10929 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
10930 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
10931
10932 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
10933
10934 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
10935 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
10936 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
10937 optionally.
10938
10939 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
10940 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
10941
10942 **
10943 The new function process-running-child-p
10944 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
10945 terminal to its own child process.
10946
10947 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
10948 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
10949 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
10950 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
10951
10952 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
10953 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
10954
10955 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
10956 :included is an alias for :visible.
10957
10958 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
10959 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
10960 to move or copy menu entries.
10961
10962 ** Multibyte editing changes
10963
10964 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
10965 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
10966 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
10967 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
10968 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
10969 (setq char (sref str idx)
10970 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
10971 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
10972
10973 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
10974 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
10975 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
10976
10977 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
10978 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
10979 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
10980
10981 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
10982
10983 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
10984 across the boundary.
10985
10986 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
10987 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
10988 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
10989 contains 8-bit characters.
10990 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
10991 contains invalid characters.
10992
10993 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
10994 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
10995 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
10996 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
10997 way.
10998
10999 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
11000 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
11001 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
11002 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
11003
11004 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
11005 compose Thai characters in a string.
11006
11007 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
11008 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
11009 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
11010 menus should always use the third argument.
11011
11012 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
11013 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
11014 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
11015 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
11016
11017 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
11018 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
11019 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
11020 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
11021
11022 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
11023 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
11024 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
11025 echo area contents.
11026
11027 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
11028
11029 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
11030 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
11031 requested feature cannot be loaded.
11032
11033 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
11034 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
11035 means to clear out that attribute.
11036
11037 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
11038 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
11039
11040 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
11041 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
11042 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
11043 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
11044
11045 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
11046 the gap of the current buffer.
11047
11048 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
11049 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
11050 current buffer.
11051
11052 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
11053 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
11054 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
11055 it back in after any modifications have been made.
11056 \f
11057 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
11058
11059 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
11060 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
11061 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
11062 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
11063 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
11064
11065 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
11066 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
11067 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
11068 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
11069 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
11070
11071 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
11072 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
11073 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
11074
11075 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
11076 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
11077 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
11078 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
11079 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
11080 results.
11081
11082 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
11083 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
11084 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
11085 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
11086 \f
11087 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
11088
11089 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
11090 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
11091 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
11092 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
11093
11094 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
11095 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
11096 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
11097 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
11098 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
11099 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
11100 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
11101 region.
11102
11103 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
11104 selective undo.
11105
11106 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
11107 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
11108 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
11109 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
11110 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
11111
11112 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
11113 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
11114 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
11115 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
11116
11117 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
11118 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
11119 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
11120 something that most users not do.
11121
11122 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
11123 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
11124 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
11125 applications.
11126
11127 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
11128 pasting operations.
11129
11130 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
11131 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
11132 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
11133 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
11134 `ps-printer-name'.
11135
11136 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
11137 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
11138 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
11139 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
11140 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
11141 hits a new word.
11142
11143 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
11144 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
11145 to be confused by TeX commands.
11146
11147 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
11148 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
11149 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
11150 of various alternative replacements and actions.
11151
11152 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
11153 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
11154 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
11155 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
11156 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
11157
11158 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
11159 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
11160
11161 ** Changes in input method usage.
11162
11163 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
11164 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
11165 respectively.
11166
11167 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
11168
11169 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
11170 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
11171
11172 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
11173 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
11174
11175 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
11176
11177 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
11178
11179 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
11180 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
11181
11182 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
11183 given in the following case:
11184 o When you are using a complex input method.
11185 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
11186
11187 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
11188 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
11189 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
11190 setting it to t is helpful.
11191
11192 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
11193
11194 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
11195 keys:
11196 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
11197 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
11198 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
11199 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
11200 environment.
11201
11202 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
11203 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
11204 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
11205 get
11206
11207 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
11208
11209 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
11210
11211 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
11212 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
11213
11214 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
11215 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
11216 its owner and group.
11217
11218 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
11219 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
11220
11221 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
11222 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
11223
11224 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
11225 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
11226 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
11227 by the left edge of the rectangle.
11228
11229 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
11230 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
11231 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
11232 for writing keyboard macros.
11233
11234 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
11235 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
11236 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
11237 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
11238 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
11239 info.
11240
11241 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
11242
11243 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
11244 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
11245 contents only.
11246
11247 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
11248 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
11249 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
11250 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
11251
11252 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
11253 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
11254 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
11255
11256 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
11257 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
11258 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
11259 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
11260
11261 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
11262 failure if the command produces no output.
11263
11264 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
11265 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
11266 the mouse.
11267
11268 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
11269 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
11270 function and variable names.
11271
11272 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
11273 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
11274 file-coding-system-alist.
11275
11276 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
11277 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
11278 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
11279 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
11280 according to the current fontset.
11281
11282 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
11283
11284 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
11285 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
11286 nonascii-insert-offset.
11287
11288 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
11289 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
11290 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
11291 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
11292
11293 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
11294 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
11295
11296 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
11297 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
11298
11299 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
11300 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
11301 command keys.
11302
11303 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
11304 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
11305
11306 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
11307 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
11308 all variables that have documentation.
11309
11310 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
11311 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
11312 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
11313 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
11314 it should show; the default is 20.
11315
11316 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
11317 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
11318 of your input.
11319
11320 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
11321 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
11322 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
11323 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
11324 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
11325 Newly added options are included as well.
11326
11327 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
11328 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
11329 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
11330
11331 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
11332 Customize menu.
11333
11334 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
11335 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
11336
11337 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
11338 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
11339 invoked.
11340
11341 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
11342 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
11343 The default is 1.
11344
11345 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
11346 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
11347 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
11348 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
11349 sensibly.
11350
11351 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
11352
11353 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
11354 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
11355 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
11356
11357 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
11358 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
11359 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
11360 every night.
11361
11362 ** Desktop changes
11363
11364 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
11365 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
11366
11367 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
11368 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
11369
11370 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
11371 read and post multi-lingual articles.
11372
11373 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
11374 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
11375 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
11376 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
11377 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
11378 made invisible again.
11379
11380 ** Mail reading and sending changes
11381
11382 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
11383 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
11384 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
11385 toggle.
11386
11387 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
11388 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
11389 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
11390 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
11391 rmail-default-body-file.
11392
11393 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
11394 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
11395 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
11396
11397 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
11398 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
11399 is evaluated to insert the signature.
11400
11401 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
11402 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
11403 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
11404 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
11405 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
11406 especially interested in trying feedmail.
11407
11408 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
11409 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
11410 provided by feedmail are:
11411
11412 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
11413 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
11414 there is also a queue for draft messages
11415
11416 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
11417 be prompted for confirmation
11418
11419 **** does smart filling of address headers
11420
11421 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
11422 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
11423 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
11424
11425 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
11426 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
11427 /usr/lib/sendmail, and Emacs Lisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
11428 function for something else (10-20 lines of Lisp code).
11429
11430 ** Dired changes
11431
11432 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
11433 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
11434
11435 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
11436 run Dired on the directory name at point.
11437
11438 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
11439 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
11440 for a specified regexp.
11441
11442 ** VC Changes
11443
11444 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
11445 conveniently.
11446
11447 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
11448 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
11449 Dired.
11450
11451 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
11452 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
11453 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
11454 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
11455
11456 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
11457 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
11458 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
11459 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
11460 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
11461
11462 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
11463 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
11464 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
11465 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
11466 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
11467
11468 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
11469 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
11470 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
11471 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
11472
11473 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
11474 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
11475 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
11476
11477 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
11478 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
11479 session to resolve them.
11480
11481 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
11482 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
11483 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
11484 uses as well).
11485
11486 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
11487 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
11488 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
11489 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
11490 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
11491 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
11492 using ediff.
11493
11494 ** Changes in Font Lock
11495
11496 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
11497 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
11498 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
11499 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
11500 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
11501
11502 ** Frame name display changes
11503
11504 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
11505 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
11506 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
11507 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
11508
11509 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
11510 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
11511 menu.
11512
11513 ** Comint (subshell) changes
11514
11515 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
11516 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
11517 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
11518
11519 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
11520
11521 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
11522 that is, the line after the last line you got.
11523 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
11524
11525 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
11526 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
11527 the following line.
11528
11529 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
11530 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
11531 previously sent input.
11532
11533 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
11534 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
11535 as the search string.
11536
11537 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
11538 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
11539
11540 ** C mode changes
11541
11542 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
11543 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
11544 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
11545 definition.
11546
11547 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
11548 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
11549 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
11550 style is still the default however.
11551
11552 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
11553
11554 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
11555 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
11556 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
11557
11558 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
11559 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
11560
11561 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
11562 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
11563
11564 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
11565 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
11566
11567 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
11568 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
11569
11570 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
11571 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
11572 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
11573 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
11574
11575 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
11576
11577 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
11578 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
11579 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
11580
11581 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
11582 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
11583 expanding dynamically.
11584
11585 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
11586 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
11587
11588 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
11589 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
11590 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
11591 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
11592
11593 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
11594
11595 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
11596
11597 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
11598 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
11599 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
11600 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
11601 against the first word in the title.
11602
11603 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
11604 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
11605 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
11606 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
11607 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
11608 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
11609
11610 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
11611 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
11612 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
11613 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
11614
11615 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
11616
11617 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
11618 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
11619 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
11620 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
11621 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
11622 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
11623
11624 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
11625 Editing group once the package is loaded.
11626
11627 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
11628 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
11629 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
11630
11631 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
11632 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
11633
11634 ** Ispell changes.
11635
11636 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
11637 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
11638 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
11639
11640 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
11641 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
11642 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
11643 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
11644 include:
11645
11646 o URLs are automatically skipped
11647 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
11648
11649 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
11650
11651 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
11652
11653 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
11654 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
11655 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
11656 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
11657
11658 *** New recursive parser.
11659
11660 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
11661 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
11662 recursive parser scans the individual files.
11663
11664 *** Parsing only part of a document.
11665
11666 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
11667 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
11668 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
11669
11670 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
11671
11672 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
11673
11674 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
11675
11676 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
11677
11678 *** Using multiple selection buffers
11679
11680 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
11681 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
11682
11683 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
11684
11685 *** References to external documents.
11686
11687 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
11688 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
11689 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
11690 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
11691 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
11692 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
11693 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
11694
11695 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
11696
11697 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
11698 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
11699
11700 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
11701 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
11702
11703 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
11704
11705 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
11706 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
11707
11708 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
11709
11710 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
11711 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
11712 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
11713 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
11714 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
11715 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
11716 more.
11717
11718 *** Support for the varioref package
11719
11720 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
11721
11722 *** New hooks
11723
11724 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
11725 and citations are created. These hooks are
11726 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
11727 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
11728
11729 *** Citations outside LaTeX
11730
11731 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
11732 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
11733
11734 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
11735
11736 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
11737 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
11738 fontified, use
11739
11740 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
11741
11742 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
11743 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
11744 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
11745 directories that contain the same file name.
11746
11747 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
11748 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
11749 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
11750 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
11751 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
11752 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
11753 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
11754 directory.
11755
11756 ** New modes and packages
11757
11758 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
11759 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
11760 it, but some do not.
11761
11762 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
11763 code.
11764
11765 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
11766 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
11767 around in a buffer.
11768
11769 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
11770
11771 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
11772 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
11773 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
11774 established system of notation similar to Chess.
11775
11776 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
11777 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
11778 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
11779
11780 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
11781 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
11782 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc.); others are implementations of
11783 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
11784 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
11785 the like.
11786
11787 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
11788 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
11789
11790 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
11791 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
11792 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
11793 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
11794
11795 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
11796
11797 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
11798 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
11799 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
11800 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
11801 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc.)
11802 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
11803 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
11804 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
11805 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
11806 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
11807 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
11808
11809 Platform-specific modes:
11810
11811 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
11812 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
11813 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
11814 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
11815 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
11816 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
11817 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
11818 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
11819 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
11820 \f
11821 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11822
11823 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
11824 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
11825 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
11826 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
11827
11828 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
11829 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
11830 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
11831
11832 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
11833 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
11834 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
11835 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
11836
11837 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
11838 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
11839 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
11840 environment.
11841
11842 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
11843 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
11844 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
11845 current input method for reading this one event.
11846
11847 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
11848 now control whether to output certain characters as
11849 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
11850 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
11851 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
11852 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
11853 \f
11854 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11855
11856 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
11857 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
11858
11859 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
11860 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
11861 always increases point by 1.
11862
11863 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
11864 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
11865
11866 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
11867
11868 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
11869 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
11870 default value changed. For example,
11871
11872 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
11873 :type 'integer
11874 :group 'foo
11875 :version "20.3")
11876
11877 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
11878 :version "20.3")
11879
11880 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
11881 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
11882 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
11883 `:version' in the top level group.
11884
11885 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
11886
11887 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
11888 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
11889
11890 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
11891 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
11892 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
11893 to themselves.
11894
11895 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
11896 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
11897 values whatever.
11898
11899 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
11900 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
11901 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
11902
11903 ** Frame-local variables.
11904
11905 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
11906 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
11907 local bindings for that variable.
11908
11909 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
11910 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
11911 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
11912 parameter name.
11913
11914 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
11915 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
11916 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
11917 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
11918
11919 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
11920 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
11921 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
11922 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
11923
11924 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
11925 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
11926 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
11927 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
11928 See the documentation in sregex.el.
11929
11930 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
11931 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
11932 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
11933 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
11934
11935 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
11936 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
11937
11938 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
11939 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
11940 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
11941
11942 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
11943 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
11944 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
11945 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
11946
11947 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
11948 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
11949 empty input.
11950
11951 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
11952 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
11953 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
11954 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
11955 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
11956
11957 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
11958 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
11959 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
11960 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
11961
11962 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
11963 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
11964 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
11965 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
11966 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
11967
11968 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
11969 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
11970 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
11971 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
11972
11973 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
11974 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
11975 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
11976
11977 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
11978 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
11979 was directed to display this buffer.
11980
11981 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
11982 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
11983 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
11984 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
11985 set-window-configuration.
11986
11987 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
11988 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
11989 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
11990 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
11991
11992 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
11993 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
11994 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
11995
11996 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
11997 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
11998 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
11999
12000 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
12001 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
12002
12003 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
12004 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
12005
12006 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
12007 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
12008 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
12009
12010 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
12011 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
12012 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
12013 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
12014
12015 ** Menu changes
12016
12017 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
12018 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
12019 better supported.
12020
12021 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
12022 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
12023 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
12024 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
12025 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
12026
12027 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
12028
12029 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
12030 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
12031 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
12032 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
12033
12034 The format is:
12035 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
12036 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
12037 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
12038 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
12039 The supported properties include
12040
12041 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
12042 item is enabled.
12043 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
12044 item should appear in the menu.
12045 :filter FILTER-FN
12046 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
12047 which will be REAL-BINDING.
12048 It should return a binding to use instead.
12049 :keys DESCRIPTION
12050 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
12051 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
12052 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
12053 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
12054 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
12055 keyboard binding.
12056 :key-sequence nil
12057 This means that the command normally has no
12058 keyboard equivalent.
12059 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
12060 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
12061 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
12062 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
12063 value says whether this button is currently selected.
12064
12065 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
12066 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
12067
12068 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
12069
12070 ** New event types
12071
12072 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
12073 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
12074 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
12075 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
12076
12077 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
12078
12079 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
12080 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
12081 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
12082 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
12083 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
12084 forward, away from the user.
12085
12086 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
12087
12088 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
12089 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
12090 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
12091 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
12092 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
12093
12094 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
12095
12096 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
12097 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
12098 that were dragged and dropped.
12099
12100 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
12101
12102 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
12103
12104 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
12105 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
12106 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
12107
12108 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
12109 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
12110 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
12111
12112 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
12113 in Emacs 19 and before.
12114
12115 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
12116 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
12117
12118 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
12119 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
12120 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
12121 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
12122
12123 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
12124 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
12125 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
12126 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
12127 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
12128
12129 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
12130 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
12131 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
12132 consistent with the new representation.
12133
12134 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
12135 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
12136 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
12137 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
12138
12139 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
12140 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
12141 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
12142
12143 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
12144 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
12145 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
12146
12147 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
12148 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
12149 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
12150
12151 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
12152 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
12153
12154 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
12155 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
12156
12157 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
12158 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
12159 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
12160 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
12161
12162 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
12163 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
12164
12165 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
12166 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
12167 buffer or string being searched.
12168
12169 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
12170 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
12171 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
12172 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
12173 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
12174 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
12175 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
12176
12177 *** Structure of coding system changed.
12178
12179 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
12180 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
12181 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
12182 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
12183 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
12184 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
12185 define-coding-system-alias.
12186
12187 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
12188 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
12189 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
12190 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
12191 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
12192 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
12193 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
12194 `iso-8859-1'.
12195
12196 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
12197 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
12198 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
12199 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
12200
12201 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
12202 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
12203 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
12204 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
12205
12206 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
12207 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
12208 This function requires a user interaction.
12209
12210 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
12211 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
12212 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
12213 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
12214 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
12215 select-safe-coding-system.
12216
12217 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
12218 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
12219 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
12220 was done.
12221
12222 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
12223 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
12224 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
12225
12226 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
12227 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
12228 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
12229 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
12230
12231 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
12232 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
12233 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
12234 converted.
12235
12236 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
12237 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
12238
12239 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
12240 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
12241 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
12242 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
12243 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
12244 range of characters.
12245
12246 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
12247 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
12248
12249 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
12250 in the current buffer at position POS.
12251
12252 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
12253 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
12254 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
12255 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
12256 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
12257 binding input-method-function to nil.
12258
12259 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
12260 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
12261 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
12262 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
12263 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
12264
12265 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
12266 subsequent events of a key sequence.
12267
12268 *** You can customize any language environment by using
12269 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
12270
12271 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
12272 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
12273 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
12274 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
12275 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
12276 \f
12277 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
12278
12279 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
12280 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
12281 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
12282 tree structure.
12283
12284 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
12285 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
12286
12287 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
12288 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
12289 in your .emacs file.)
12290
12291 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
12292 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
12293
12294 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
12295 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
12296
12297 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
12298 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
12299 kills the region.
12300
12301 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
12302 delete the character before point, as usual.
12303
12304 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
12305 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
12306 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
12307
12308 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
12309 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
12310 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
12311 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
12312 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
12313 past.)
12314
12315 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
12316 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
12317 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
12318 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
12319 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
12320
12321 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
12322 and is an alias for it.
12323
12324 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
12325 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
12326
12327 ** Scrolling changes
12328
12329 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
12330 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
12331
12332 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
12333 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
12334 where it started.
12335
12336 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
12337 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
12338 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
12339 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
12340
12341 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
12342 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
12343 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
12344 recenters the window.
12345
12346 ** International character set support (MULE)
12347
12348 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
12349 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
12350 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
12351 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
12352 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
12353 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
12354
12355 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
12356 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
12357 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
12358 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
12359 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
12360
12361 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
12362 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
12363 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
12364 language, to make it possible to type them.
12365
12366 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
12367 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
12368
12369 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
12370 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
12371
12372 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
12373
12374 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
12375
12376 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
12377 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
12378 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
12379 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
12380 characters for their work until they want to change.
12381
12382 *** Input methods
12383
12384 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
12385 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
12386 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
12387 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
12388 support several input methods.
12389
12390 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
12391 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
12392 work.
12393
12394 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
12395 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
12396 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
12397 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
12398 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
12399 letter.
12400
12401 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
12402 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
12403 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
12404 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
12405 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
12406
12407 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
12408 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
12409 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
12410 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
12411
12412 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
12413 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
12414 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
12415 the first guess is wrong.
12416
12417 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
12418 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
12419
12420 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
12421 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
12422 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
12423 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
12424
12425 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
12426 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
12427 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
12428 translate automatically to and from either one.
12429
12430 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
12431
12432 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
12433 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
12434 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
12435 what you want.
12436
12437 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
12438 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
12439 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
12440 multibyte characters in that buffer.
12441
12442 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
12443 character conversion as well.
12444
12445 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
12446
12447 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
12448 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
12449 requires using many fonts.
12450
12451 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
12452 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
12453
12454 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
12455 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
12456 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
12457 you would use a font.
12458
12459 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
12460 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
12461 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
12462
12463 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
12464 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
12465 characters).
12466
12467 *** Defining fontsets.
12468
12469 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
12470 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
12471 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
12472
12473 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
12474 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
12475 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
12476 standard fontset are created automatically.
12477
12478 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
12479 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
12480 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
12481 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
12482 name is `fontset-startup'.
12483
12484 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
12485 The resource value should have this form:
12486 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
12487 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
12488 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
12489 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
12490 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
12491 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
12492 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
12493 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
12494 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
12495
12496 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
12497 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
12498 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
12499
12500 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
12501 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
12502 following resource,
12503 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
12504 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
12505 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
12506 Here is the substitution rule:
12507 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
12508 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
12509 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
12510 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
12511 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
12512
12513 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
12514 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
12515 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
12516
12517 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
12518 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
12519 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
12520 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
12521 fontsets.
12522
12523 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
12524 defaults for a particular choice of language.
12525
12526 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
12527 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
12528 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
12529 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
12530 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
12531 system for new files that you create.
12532
12533 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
12534 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
12535 whole Emacs session.
12536
12537 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
12538 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
12539 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
12540
12541 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
12542 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
12543 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
12544 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
12545 coding systems that Emacs supports.
12546
12547 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
12548 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
12549 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
12550 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
12551 is used for *the immediately following command*.
12552
12553 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
12554 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
12555
12556 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
12557 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
12558
12559 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
12560 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
12561
12562 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
12563 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
12564 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
12565 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
12566 of the file.
12567
12568 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
12569 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
12570 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
12571 translated into that character code.
12572
12573 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
12574 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
12575
12576 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
12577
12578 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
12579 the coding system for keyboard input.
12580
12581 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
12582 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
12583 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
12584
12585 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
12586
12587 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
12588 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
12589 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
12590 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
12591 designed to work with terminals.
12592
12593 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
12594 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
12595 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
12596 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
12597 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
12598 in the corresponding buffer.
12599
12600 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
12601
12602 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
12603 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
12604 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
12605
12606 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
12607 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
12608 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
12609 want to use.
12610
12611 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
12612 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
12613
12614 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
12615 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
12616 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
12617 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
12618
12619 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
12620 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
12621 related information.
12622
12623 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
12624 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
12625 scripts.
12626
12627 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
12628 information about the support for a particular language.
12629 You specify the language as an argument.
12630
12631 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
12632 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
12633 first dash.
12634
12635 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
12636 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
12637 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
12638 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
12639
12640 A alternativnyj (Russian)
12641 B big5 (Chinese)
12642 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
12643 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
12644 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
12645 E euc-japan (Japanese)
12646 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12647 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
12648 K euc-korea (Korean)
12649 R koi8 (Russian)
12650 Q tibetan
12651 S shift_jis (Japanese)
12652 T lao
12653 T tis620 (Thai)
12654 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
12655 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12656 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
12657 v viqr (Vietnamese)
12658 z hz (Chinese)
12659
12660 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
12661 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
12662 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
12663 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
12664
12665 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
12666 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
12667
12668 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
12669 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
12670 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
12671 Rmail files themselves.
12672
12673 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
12674 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
12675
12676 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
12677 for sending mail:
12678
12679 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
12680 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
12681 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
12682 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
12683 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
12684
12685 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
12686 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
12687 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
12688 translations.
12689
12690 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
12691 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
12692 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
12693 without any conversion.
12694
12695 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
12696 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
12697 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
12698 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
12699
12700 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
12701 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
12702
12703 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
12704 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
12705
12706 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
12707 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
12708
12709 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
12710 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
12711 in the buffer before point.
12712
12713 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
12714 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
12715 you are using.
12716
12717 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
12718 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
12719
12720 ** File locking works with NFS now.
12721
12722 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
12723 in the same directory as FILENAME.
12724
12725 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
12726 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
12727 can become a bottleneck.
12728
12729 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
12730 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
12731 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
12732 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
12733 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
12734 so useful that the change is worth while.
12735
12736 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
12737 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
12738 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
12739 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
12740
12741 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
12742 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
12743 show-paren-mode.
12744
12745 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
12746 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
12747 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
12748
12749 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
12750 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
12751 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
12752
12753 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
12754 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
12755 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
12756
12757 ** Changes in View mode.
12758
12759 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
12760 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
12761
12762 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
12763 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
12764
12765 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
12766 previous state.
12767
12768 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
12769 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
12770
12771 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
12772 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
12773 not just the selected window.
12774
12775 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
12776 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
12777 turns View mode on or off.
12778
12779 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
12780 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
12781 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
12782
12783 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
12784 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
12785
12786 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
12787 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
12788 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
12789 which version to compare with.
12790
12791 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
12792 blocks if a match is inside the block.
12793
12794 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
12795 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
12796 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
12797 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
12798
12799 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
12800 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
12801 blocks, all of them or none.
12802
12803 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
12804 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
12805 confirmation first.
12806
12807 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
12808 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
12809 However, the mode will not be changed if
12810 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
12811 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
12812 not suitable for ordinary files, or
12813 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
12814
12815 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
12816
12817 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
12818 these commands do not change the major mode.
12819
12820 ** M-x occur changes.
12821
12822 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
12823 it performs a case-sensitive search.
12824
12825 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
12826 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
12827 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
12828
12829 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
12830 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
12831 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
12832 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
12833 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
12834
12835 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
12836 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
12837 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
12838 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
12839
12840 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
12841 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
12842 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
12843
12844 ** Outline mode changes.
12845
12846 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
12847
12848 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
12849
12850 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
12851 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
12852 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
12853 was already active.
12854
12855 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
12856 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
12857 get confused by it.
12858
12859 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
12860 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
12861
12862 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
12863
12864 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
12865 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
12866 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
12867 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
12868
12869 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
12870 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
12871 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
12872
12873 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
12874 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
12875 values.
12876
12877 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
12878 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
12879 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
12880 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
12881
12882 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
12883 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
12884 can be. The default value is 30.
12885
12886 ** Changes in Mail mode.
12887
12888 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
12889 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
12890 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
12891 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
12892 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
12893 behavior.
12894
12895 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
12896 compose-mail-other-frame.
12897
12898 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
12899 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
12900 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
12901 buffer that shows the original message.
12902
12903 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
12904 with separator lines around the contents.
12905
12906 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
12907 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
12908 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
12909 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
12910
12911 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
12912
12913 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
12914 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
12915 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
12916 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
12917
12918 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
12919 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
12920 /etc/passwd.
12921
12922 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
12923 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
12924 /etc/passwd.
12925
12926 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
12927 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
12928 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
12929 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
12930
12931 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
12932 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
12933 be taken to be magic.
12934
12935 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
12936 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
12937 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
12938
12939 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
12940 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
12941
12942 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
12943 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
12944
12945 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
12946
12947 new key dired.el binding old key
12948 ------- ---------------- -------
12949 * c dired-change-marks c
12950 * m dired-mark m
12951 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
12952 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
12953 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
12954 * u dired-unmark u
12955 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
12956 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
12957 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
12958 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
12959 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
12960 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
12961
12962 ** Rmail changes.
12963
12964 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
12965 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
12966 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
12967 each time you run it.
12968
12969 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
12970 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
12971
12972 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
12973 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
12974 means to move in the opposite direction.
12975
12976 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
12977 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
12978
12979 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
12980 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
12981 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
12982 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
12983 for output.
12984
12985 ** Gnus changes.
12986
12987 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
12988
12989 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
12990 Gnus.
12991
12992 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
12993 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
12994
12995 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
12996 article mode line.
12997
12998 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
12999
13000 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
13001
13002 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
13003
13004 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
13005 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
13006 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
13007
13008 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
13009
13010 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
13011
13012 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
13013 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
13014
13015 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
13016 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
13017 used to pick articles.
13018
13019 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
13020 another have been added.
13021
13022 `M-x gnus-change-server'
13023
13024 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
13025 generating lines in buffers.
13026
13027 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
13028 `C-M-_'.
13029
13030 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
13031
13032 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
13033
13034 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
13035
13036 *** Scores can be decayed.
13037
13038 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
13039
13040 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
13041 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
13042
13043 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
13044 the native server.
13045
13046 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
13047
13048 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
13049 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
13050
13051 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
13052
13053 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
13054 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
13055
13056 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
13057 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
13058
13059 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
13060 a group.
13061
13062 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
13063 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
13064
13065 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
13066
13067 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
13068
13069 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
13070
13071 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
13072
13073 Use the `Y c' command.
13074
13075 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
13076
13077 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
13078
13079 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
13080
13081 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
13082 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
13083
13084 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
13085
13086 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
13087
13088 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
13089 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
13090
13091 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
13092
13093 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
13094 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
13095 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
13096 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
13097 this issue.)
13098
13099 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
13100 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
13101 particular news group. This can be done by:
13102
13103 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
13104
13105 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
13106 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
13107 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
13108 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
13109 for reading and posting).
13110
13111 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
13112 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
13113 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
13114 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
13115 there.
13116
13117 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
13118 default. Here are some of these default settings:
13119
13120 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
13121 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
13122 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
13123 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
13124 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
13125
13126 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
13127 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
13128
13129 ** CC mode changes.
13130
13131 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
13132 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
13133 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
13134 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
13135 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
13136 loaded.
13137
13138 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
13139 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
13140 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
13141 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
13142 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
13143 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
13144
13145 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
13146 of the current buffer.
13147
13148 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
13149 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
13150 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
13151
13152 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
13153 style that the Python developers like.
13154
13155 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
13156 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
13157 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
13158
13159 ** VC Changes [new]
13160
13161 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
13162 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
13163 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
13164
13165 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
13166 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
13167 developers.
13168
13169 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
13170 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
13171
13172 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
13173 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
13174 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
13175 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
13176
13177 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
13178 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
13179
13180 ** Calendar changes.
13181
13182 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
13183 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
13184 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
13185 following/previous years.
13186
13187 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
13188 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
13189 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
13190 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
13191 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
13192 supposed attribute of God.
13193
13194 ** ps-print changes
13195
13196 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
13197 layout.
13198
13199 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
13200
13201 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
13202 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
13203 printer system has this behavior, set variable
13204 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
13205
13206 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
13207 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
13208 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
13209
13210 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
13211 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
13212
13213 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
13214 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
13215 printing for your printer.
13216
13217 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
13218 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
13219
13220 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
13221 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
13222
13223 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
13224 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
13225 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
13226 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
13227 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
13228 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
13229 The default value is nil.
13230
13231 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
13232 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
13233
13234 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
13235 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
13236 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
13237 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
13238 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
13239 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
13240 color). The default is 0 ("black").
13241
13242 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
13243 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
13244
13245 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
13246 The default is 0 ("black").
13247
13248 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
13249 The default is 0 ("black").
13250
13251 border-width Specify the border width.
13252 The default is 0.4.
13253
13254 Any other property is ignored.
13255
13256 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
13257 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
13258 documentation).
13259
13260 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
13261 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
13262 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
13263 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
13264 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
13265 controlling headers.
13266
13267 *** Color management (subgroup)
13268
13269 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
13270 color.
13271
13272 *** Face Management (subgroup)
13273
13274 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
13275 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
13276 background should be used. Valid values are:
13277
13278 t always use face background color.
13279 nil never use face background color.
13280 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
13281
13282 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
13283
13284 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
13285 sheet of paper.
13286
13287 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
13288 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
13289
13290 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
13291 each page.
13292
13293 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
13294 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
13295 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
13296
13297 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
13298 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
13299 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
13300
13301 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
13302 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
13303 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
13304
13305 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
13306 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
13307 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
13308
13309 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
13310 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
13311 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
13312
13313 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
13314
13315 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
13316
13317 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
13318 RGB color.
13319
13320 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
13321 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
13322 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
13323
13324 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
13325 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13326 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13327 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13328 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13329 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
13330 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
13331 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
13332 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13333 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13334 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13335 10 + 10 +
13336 11 + 11 +
13337 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13338 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13339 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
13340 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
13341 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
13342 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13343 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13344 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13345 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
13346 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
13347 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
13348 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
13349 22 + 22 +
13350 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13351
13352 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
13353
13354
13355 *** Printer management (subgroup)
13356
13357 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
13358 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
13359 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
13360 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
13361 to "-P".
13362
13363 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
13364 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
13365 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
13366
13367 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
13368 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
13369 do so.
13370
13371 *** Page settings (subgroup)
13372
13373 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
13374 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
13375 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
13376 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
13377 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
13378 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
13379 `setpagedevice'.
13380
13381 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
13382 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
13383 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
13384
13385 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
13386 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
13387 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
13388 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
13389 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
13390 its TO, are ignored.
13391
13392 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
13393 pages. Valid values are:
13394
13395 nil print all pages.
13396
13397 `even-page' print only even pages.
13398
13399 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
13400
13401 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
13402 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
13403 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
13404 print only the even sheet of paper.
13405
13406 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
13407 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
13408 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
13409 only the odd sheet of paper.
13410
13411 Any other value is treated as nil.
13412
13413 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
13414 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
13415 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
13416
13417 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
13418
13419 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
13420 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
13421
13422 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
13423 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
13424 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
13425 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
13426 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
13427 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
13428 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
13429
13430 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
13431 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
13432 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
13433 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
13434 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
13435 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
13436 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
13437
13438 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
13439
13440 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
13441 messages should be sent.
13442
13443 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
13444 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
13445 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
13446
13447 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
13448
13449 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
13450 points for line numbers.
13451
13452 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
13453 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
13454
13455 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
13456 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
13457 to 2, the printing will look like:
13458
13459 1 one line
13460 one line
13461 3 one line
13462 one line
13463 5 one line
13464 one line
13465 ...
13466
13467 Valid values are:
13468
13469 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
13470 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
13471 is used.
13472
13473 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
13474 zebra stripe is to be printed.
13475
13476 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
13477
13478 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
13479 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
13480 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
13481 3, the output will look like:
13482
13483 one line
13484 one line
13485 3 one line
13486 one line
13487 one line
13488 6 one line
13489 one line
13490 one line
13491 9 one line
13492 one line
13493 ...
13494
13495 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
13496 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
13497
13498 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
13499 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
13500 `ps-font-size').
13501
13502 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
13503 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
13504 `ps-font-size').
13505
13506 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
13507
13508 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
13509 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
13510
13511 ** hideshow changes.
13512
13513 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
13514 C++, ; for lisp).
13515
13516 *** Support for java-mode added.
13517
13518 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
13519 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
13520
13521 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
13522 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
13523 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
13524
13525 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
13526 robust and a lot faster.
13527
13528 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
13529
13530 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
13531 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
13532 documentation for more details.
13533
13534 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
13535
13536 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
13537 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
13538 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
13539 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
13540 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
13541
13542 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
13543 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
13544 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
13545 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
13546
13547 ** Font Lock mode
13548
13549 *** Custom support
13550
13551 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
13552 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify
13553 the faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new
13554 custom group font-lock-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in your
13555 ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
13556 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
13557
13558 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
13559
13560 *** Maximum decoration
13561
13562 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
13563 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
13564 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
13565 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
13566 to get the old behavior.
13567
13568 *** New support
13569
13570 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
13571
13572 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
13573 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
13574
13575 *** Configurable support
13576
13577 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
13578 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
13579 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
13580 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
13581 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
13582 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
13583 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
13584
13585 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
13586 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
13587 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
13588
13589 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
13590
13591 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
13592 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
13593 for any mode.
13594
13595 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
13596
13597 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
13598
13599 in your ~/.emacs.
13600
13601 *** New faces
13602
13603 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
13604 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
13605 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
13606 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
13607
13608 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
13609
13610 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
13611 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
13612 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
13613
13614 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
13615
13616 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
13617 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
13618 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
13619 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
13620 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
13621 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
13622 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
13623
13624 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
13625 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
13626 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
13627 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
13628 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
13629 the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
13630
13631 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
13632
13633 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
13634 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
13635 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
13636 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
13637
13638 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
13639 settings.
13640
13641 ** Ada mode changes.
13642
13643 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
13644 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
13645 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
13646 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
13647 stubs.
13648
13649 *** There are two new commands:
13650 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
13651 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
13652
13653 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
13654 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
13655 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
13656
13657 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
13658 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
13659 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
13660
13661 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
13662 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
13663 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
13664 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
13665
13666 ** Scheme mode changes.
13667
13668 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
13669 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
13670 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
13671 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
13672 have any effect.
13673
13674 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
13675 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
13676 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
13677 variables as buffer-local variables.
13678
13679 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
13680 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
13681
13682 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
13683
13684 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
13685 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
13686 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
13687 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
13688
13689 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
13690 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
13691 buffer in Emacs.
13692
13693 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
13694 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
13695 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
13696 option takes precedence.
13697
13698 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
13699 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
13700 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
13701
13702 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
13703 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
13704 the current defun.
13705
13706 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
13707 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
13708
13709 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
13710 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
13711 necessary).
13712
13713 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
13714 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
13715 these register values no longer become completely useless.
13716 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
13717 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
13718 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
13719
13720 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
13721 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
13722 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
13723 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
13724
13725 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
13726 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
13727 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
13728 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
13729 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
13730
13731 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
13732 since it applies only to the current frame.
13733
13734 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
13735 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
13736 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
13737
13738 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
13739 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
13740 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
13741 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
13742 instead of just the file you are editing.
13743
13744 ** RefTeX mode
13745
13746 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
13747 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
13748 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
13749 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
13750 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
13751
13752 C-c ( reftex-label
13753 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
13754 knows which kind of label is needed.
13755
13756 C-c ) reftex-reference
13757 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
13758 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
13759
13760 C-c [ reftex-citation
13761 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
13762 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
13763
13764 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
13765 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
13766
13767 C-c = reftex-toc
13768 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
13769 can quickly jump to every section.
13770
13771 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
13772 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
13773 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
13774 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
13775 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
13776
13777 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
13778
13779 *** Info documentation is now available.
13780
13781 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
13782 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
13783
13784 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
13785 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
13786
13787 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
13788 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
13789
13790 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
13791 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
13792 appropriate functions.
13793
13794 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
13795 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
13796
13797 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
13798 been cleaned.
13799
13800 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
13801 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
13802
13803 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
13804 shall be delimited.
13805
13806 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
13807 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
13808 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
13809
13810 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
13811 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
13812 prefixed with `ALT'.
13813
13814 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
13815 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
13816 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
13817 documentation).
13818
13819 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
13820 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
13821 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
13822
13823 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
13824 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
13825
13826 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
13827 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
13828 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
13829
13830 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
13831
13832 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
13833
13834 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
13835 from alien sources.
13836
13837 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
13838 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
13839 crossref entries.
13840
13841 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
13842 region.
13843
13844 *** Added support for imenu.
13845
13846 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
13847 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
13848 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
13849 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
13850
13851 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
13852 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
13853
13854 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
13855
13856 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
13857
13858 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
13859 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
13860 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
13861 as an argument.
13862
13863 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
13864 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
13865
13866 ** browse-url changes
13867
13868 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
13869 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
13870 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
13871 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
13872 customization variables.
13873
13874 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
13875
13876 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
13877 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
13878 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
13879
13880 ** Changes in Ediff
13881
13882 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
13883 pops up the Info file for this command.
13884
13885 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
13886 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
13887 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
13888 directories).
13889
13890 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
13891 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
13892 files in the same directory.
13893
13894 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
13895 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
13896 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
13897
13898 ** Changes in Viper
13899
13900 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
13901 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
13902 instead of vip-.
13903 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
13904 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
13905 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
13906 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
13907 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
13908 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
13909 color when Viper is in insert state.
13910 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
13911 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
13912 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
13913
13914 ** Etags changes.
13915
13916 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
13917 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
13918 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
13919 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
13920 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
13921
13922 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
13923
13924 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
13925 constructs are tagged. Files are recognized by the extension .java.
13926
13927 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
13928 recognized by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
13929 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
13930
13931 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
13932 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
13933 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
13934 methods and protocols.
13935
13936 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognized by the extension
13937 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
13938 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
13939 paragraph name.
13940
13941 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
13942 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
13943 at least M times and as many as N times.
13944
13945 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
13946 in files has changed slightly.
13947
13948 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
13949 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
13950 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
13951 with old time-stamp-format values.
13952
13953 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
13954 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
13955 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
13956 reasons.
13957
13958 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
13959 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
13960 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
13961 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
13962 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
13963 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
13964
13965 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
13966 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
13967 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
13968
13969 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
13970 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
13971 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
13972 recommended now will continue to work then.
13973
13974 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
13975 details.
13976
13977 ** There are some additional major modes:
13978
13979 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
13980 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
13981 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
13982
13983 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
13984 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
13985 into Emacs.
13986
13987 ** New Lisp packages include:
13988
13989 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
13990
13991 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
13992 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
13993
13994 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
13995
13996 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
13997 in shell buffers.
13998
13999 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
14000 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
14001 and `elint-defun'.
14002
14003 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
14004 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
14005 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
14006 strings or comments.
14007
14008 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
14009 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
14010 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
14011 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
14012 at these points.
14013
14014 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
14015 can visit them by short forms of their names.
14016
14017 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
14018 Emacs Lisp function at point.
14019
14020 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
14021
14022 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
14023 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
14024
14025 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
14026
14027 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
14028
14029 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
14030
14031 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
14032 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
14033
14034 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
14035 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
14036 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
14037 original place after inserting the copy.
14038
14039 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
14040 on the buffer.
14041
14042 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
14043 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
14044 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
14045
14046 Enable mouse-drag with:
14047 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
14048 -or-
14049 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
14050
14051 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
14052 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
14053
14054 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
14055 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
14056
14057 *** ogonek
14058
14059 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
14060 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
14061 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
14062 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
14063 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
14064 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
14065 instance) and vice versa.
14066
14067 To use this package load it using
14068 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
14069 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
14070 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
14071 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
14072 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
14073 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
14074
14075 *** Interface to ph.
14076
14077 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
14078
14079 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
14080 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
14081 these servers.
14082
14083 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
14084
14085 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
14086 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
14087 while the real cursor does not move.
14088
14089 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
14090 for visiting your favorite web sites.
14091
14092 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
14093 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
14094
14095 ** movemail change
14096
14097 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
14098 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
14099 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
14100 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
14101
14102 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
14103 \f
14104 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
14105
14106 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
14107
14108 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
14109 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
14110 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
14111 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
14112 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
14113
14114 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
14115 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
14116 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
14117 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
14118 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
14119 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
14120 \f
14121 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
14122
14123 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
14124 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
14125 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
14126 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
14127
14128 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
14129 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
14130
14131 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
14132 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
14133 "win".
14134
14135 ** Basic Lisp changes
14136
14137 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
14138 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
14139
14140 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
14141 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
14142 or by the user.
14143
14144 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
14145
14146 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
14147
14148 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
14149 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
14150
14151 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
14152 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
14153 its argument.
14154
14155 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
14156
14157 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
14158
14159 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
14160
14161 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
14162 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
14163 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
14164 `format' function.
14165
14166 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
14167 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
14168 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
14169
14170 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
14171 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
14172 adding one of these suffixes.
14173
14174 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
14175 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
14176 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
14177
14178 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
14179 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
14180
14181 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
14182
14183 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
14184 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
14185
14186 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
14187 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
14188
14189 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
14190
14191 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
14192 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
14193
14194 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
14195 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
14196 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
14197 works using `save-current-buffer'.
14198
14199 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
14200 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
14201 of the last form.
14202
14203 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
14204 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
14205 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
14206 as the last form.
14207
14208 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
14209 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
14210 matches.
14211
14212 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
14213
14214 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
14215 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
14216 Then it returns that string.
14217
14218 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
14219
14220 (with-output-to-string
14221 (princ "The buffer is ")
14222 (princ (buffer-name)))
14223
14224 returns "The buffer is foo".
14225
14226 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
14227 is non-nil.
14228
14229 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
14230 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
14231 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
14232
14233 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
14234 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
14235
14236 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
14237 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
14238 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
14239 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
14240 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
14241 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
14242
14243 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
14244 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
14245 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
14246 characters".
14247
14248 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
14249 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
14250 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
14251 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
14252 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
14253
14254 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
14255 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
14256 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
14257 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
14258
14259 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
14260 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
14261
14262 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
14263
14264 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
14265 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
14266 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
14267 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
14268 guaranteed.
14269
14270 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
14271 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
14272 character).
14273
14274 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
14275
14276 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
14277 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
14278 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
14279 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
14280 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
14281
14282 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
14283
14284 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
14285 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
14286 more than the number of characters.
14287
14288 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
14289 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
14290 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
14291 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
14292 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
14293 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
14294
14295 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
14296 and returns a string containing those characters.
14297
14298 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
14299 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
14300 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
14301 character, sref signals an error.
14302
14303 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
14304 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
14305 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
14306
14307 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
14308 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
14309 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
14310
14311 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
14312 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
14313 to a vector of the characters in it.
14314
14315 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
14316 of a string. You call it as follows:
14317
14318 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
14319
14320 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
14321 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
14322 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
14323 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
14324 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
14325
14326 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
14327 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
14328
14329 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
14330 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
14331
14332 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
14333 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
14334 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
14335 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
14336
14337 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
14338
14339 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
14340
14341 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
14342 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
14343 are not included in the resulting value.
14344
14345 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
14346 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
14347 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
14348 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
14349
14350 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
14351 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
14352 character extends across that column), then the padding character
14353 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
14354 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
14355 column START-COLUMN.
14356
14357 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
14358 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
14359 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
14360 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
14361 changed text, before the change.
14362
14363 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
14364 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
14365 one character set for each script, not for each language.
14366
14367 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
14368
14369 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
14370
14371 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
14372 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
14373
14374 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
14375 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
14376 which identify the character within that character set.
14377
14378 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
14379 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
14380 opposite of split-char.
14381
14382 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
14383 of all the characters between BEG and END.
14384
14385 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
14386 of all the characters in a string.
14387
14388 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
14389 and specifying coding systems.
14390
14391 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
14392 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
14393 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
14394 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
14395 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
14396 as what to do about code conversion.)
14397
14398 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
14399 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
14400
14401 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
14402 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
14403 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
14404
14405 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
14406 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
14407 to match against a file name.
14408
14409 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
14410 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
14411 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
14412 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
14413 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
14414 specifies the coding system for encoding.
14415
14416 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
14417 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
14418
14419 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
14420 the coding system to use for network sockets.
14421
14422 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
14423 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
14424 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
14425 service names.
14426
14427 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
14428 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
14429 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
14430 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
14431 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
14432 specifies the coding system for encoding.
14433
14434 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
14435 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
14436
14437 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
14438 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
14439 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
14440 start the subprocess.
14441
14442 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
14443 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
14444 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
14445 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
14446 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
14447
14448 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
14449 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
14450 subprocess.
14451
14452 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
14453 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
14454 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
14455 connection permanently or until overridden.
14456
14457 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
14458 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
14459 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
14460 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
14461 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
14462 system for one operation at a time.
14463
14464 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
14465 files, subprocesses or network connections.
14466
14467 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
14468 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
14469 The value is a cons cell,
14470 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
14471 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
14472 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
14473 input to the subprocess.
14474
14475 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
14476 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
14477
14478 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
14479 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
14480 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
14481
14482 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
14483 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
14484 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
14485 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
14486 customization.
14487
14488 Thus, instead of writing
14489
14490 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
14491 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
14492
14493 you would now write this:
14494
14495 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
14496 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
14497 :type 'boolean
14498 :group foo)
14499
14500 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
14501 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
14502 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
14503 for a description of them.
14504
14505 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
14506 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
14507
14508 (defgroup ispell nil
14509 "Spell checking using Ispell."
14510 :group 'processes)
14511
14512 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
14513 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
14514 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
14515 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
14516 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
14517
14518 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
14519 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
14520 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
14521 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
14522 first-level subgroups.
14523
14524 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
14525
14526 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
14527 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
14528
14529 ** easy-mmode
14530
14531 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
14532 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
14533 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
14534 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
14535 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
14536 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
14537
14538 ** Text property changes
14539
14540 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
14541 text property.
14542
14543 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
14544 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
14545 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
14546 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
14547 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
14548
14549 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
14550 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
14551 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
14552 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
14553
14554 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
14555 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
14556 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
14557
14558 ** Changes in invisibility features
14559
14560 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
14561 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
14562 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
14563 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
14564 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
14565 make the overlay visible.
14566
14567 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
14568 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
14569 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
14570 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
14571 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
14572 t when it should hide it.
14573
14574 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
14575
14576 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
14577 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
14578 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
14579 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
14580 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
14581 Here is an example of how to do this:
14582
14583 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
14584 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14585 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
14586 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14587
14588 ...
14589 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
14590
14591 ...
14592 ;; When done with the overlays:
14593 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14594 ;; Or respectively:
14595 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14596
14597 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
14598
14599 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
14600 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
14601 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
14602 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
14603
14604 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
14605 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
14606 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
14607
14608 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
14609 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
14610
14611 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
14612 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
14613
14614 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
14615 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
14616 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
14617
14618 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
14619 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
14620 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
14621 determine the syntax type of the character.
14622
14623 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
14624 of the current buffer.
14625
14626 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
14627 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
14628 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
14629
14630 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
14631 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
14632 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
14633 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
14634 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
14635
14636 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
14637 text property.
14638
14639 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
14640 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
14641 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
14642
14643 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
14644 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
14645 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
14646 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
14647 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
14648
14649 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
14650 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
14651 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
14652
14653 ** Changes in face features
14654
14655 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
14656 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
14657
14658 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
14659 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
14660
14661 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
14662 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
14663
14664 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
14665 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
14666
14667 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
14668 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
14669 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
14670 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
14671 overlay property).
14672
14673 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
14674 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
14675
14676 ** Changes in file-handling functions
14677
14678 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
14679 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
14680 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
14681 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
14682
14683 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
14684 begins with ~.
14685
14686 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
14687 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
14688
14689 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
14690 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
14691
14692 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
14693 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
14694
14695 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
14696 character code conversion as well as other things.
14697
14698 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
14699 (formerly it did not).
14700
14701 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
14702 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
14703
14704 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
14705 instead of constant strings.
14706
14707 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
14708 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
14709 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
14710
14711 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
14712 in the same way as before.
14713
14714 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
14715 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
14716 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
14717
14718 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
14719 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
14720 else, and returns nil.
14721
14722 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
14723 directory cannot be listed.
14724
14725 ** Changes in minibuffer input
14726
14727 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
14728 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
14729 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
14730 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
14731 ways:
14732
14733 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
14734 It is available through the history command M-n.
14735
14736 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
14737 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
14738 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
14739 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
14740 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
14741
14742 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
14743 argument in this way.
14744
14745 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
14746 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
14747 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
14748
14749 ** Echo area features
14750
14751 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
14752 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
14753 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
14754 after the echo area is cleared.
14755
14756 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
14757 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
14758
14759 ** Keyboard input features
14760
14761 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
14762 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
14763
14764 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
14765 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
14766 by keyboard macros.
14767
14768 ** Frame-related changes
14769
14770 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
14771 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
14772 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
14773
14774 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
14775 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
14776 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
14777
14778 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
14779 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
14780 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
14781 in the selected frame.
14782
14783 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
14784 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
14785 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
14786
14787 ** X Windows features
14788
14789 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
14790 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
14791 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
14792
14793 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
14794 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
14795
14796 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
14797 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
14798 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
14799
14800 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
14801 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
14802
14803 ** Subprocess features
14804
14805 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
14806 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
14807 automatically.
14808
14809 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
14810 and returns the output from the command as a string.
14811
14812 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
14813 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
14814
14815 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
14816 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
14817
14818 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
14819 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
14820 goes after the other menu items.
14821
14822 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
14823 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
14824 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
14825 are in use.
14826
14827 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
14828 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
14829
14830 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
14831 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
14832 form.
14833
14834 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
14835 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
14836 but its hook is still run.
14837
14838 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
14839 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
14840
14841 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
14842 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
14843 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
14844
14845 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
14846 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
14847 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
14848 warned.
14849
14850 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
14851 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
14852
14853 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
14854 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
14855 functions like display-time.
14856
14857 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
14858 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
14859
14860 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
14861 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
14862 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
14863
14864 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
14865 if there is an error in compilation.
14866
14867 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
14868 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
14869 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
14870 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
14871
14872 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
14873 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
14874 the *scratch* buffer.
14875
14876 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
14877 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
14878 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
14879 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
14880
14881 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
14882 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
14883 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
14884
14885 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
14886 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
14887 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
14888 and compose-mail-other-frame.
14889
14890 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
14891 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
14892 full name of the specified user will be returned.
14893
14894 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
14895 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
14896 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
14897 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
14898 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
14899 files at all.
14900
14901 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
14902 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
14903 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
14904 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
14905
14906 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
14907 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
14908 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
14909 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
14910
14911 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
14912
14913 ** imenu.el changes.
14914
14915 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
14916 item from menu created by imenu.
14917
14918 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
14919 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
14920 select one of those items.
14921 \f
14922 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
14923
14924 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
14925 Copyright information:
14926
14927 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004,
14928 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14929
14930 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
14931 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
14932 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
14933 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
14934
14935 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
14936 of this document, or of portions of it,
14937 under the above conditions, provided also that they
14938 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
14939 \f
14940 Local variables:
14941 mode: outline
14942 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
14943 end:
14944
14945 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793